1 ==============================
2 LLVM Language Reference Manual
3 ==============================
12 This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13 is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14 type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15 representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16 representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
22 The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23 forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24 (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25 readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26 powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27 transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28 and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29 all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30 representation and notation.
32 The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33 being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34 a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35 high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36 microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37 be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38 the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39 can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40 the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41 instead of a memory location.
48 It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50 and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51 instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
57 because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58 LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59 verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60 run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61 before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62 pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
69 LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72 ``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73 identifiers, for different purposes:
75 #. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
78 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
79 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
82 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global values to suppress mangling.
84 #. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
86 #. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
88 LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90 of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91 Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92 with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
95 Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97 '``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98 '``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99 with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100 (``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
102 Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
111 After strength reduction:
115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
125 This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126 lexical features of LLVM:
128 #. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129 #. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
131 #. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
137 It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139 that defines the type and name of value produced.
147 LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148 translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149 functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150 combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151 global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152 symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
162 ; Definition of main function
163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8*...
165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
176 This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177 "``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178 :ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179 :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
181 In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182 functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184 to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185 following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
192 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with a private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206 ``available_externally``
207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
244 .. _linkage_appending:
247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
254 Unfortunately this doesn't correspond to any feature in .o files, so it
255 can only be used for variables like ``llvm.global_ctors`` which llvm
256 interprets specially.
259 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
260 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
261 instead of being an undefined reference.
262 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
263 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
264 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
265 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
266 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
267 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
268 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
269 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
271 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
272 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
273 resolve external symbol references.
275 It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
276 other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
283 LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
284 :ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
285 specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
286 caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
287 The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
290 "``ccc``" - The C calling convention
291 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
292 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
293 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
294 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
295 the function (as does normal C).
296 "``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
297 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
298 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
299 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
300 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
301 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
302 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
303 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
304 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
305 match the prototype of the function definition.
306 "``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
307 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
308 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
309 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
310 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
311 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
312 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
313 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
315 "``cc 10``" - GHC convention
316 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
317 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
318 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
319 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
320 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
321 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
322 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
323 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
326 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
327 floating-point types are supported.
328 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
329 floating-point parameters.
331 This calling convention supports `tail call
332 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
333 caller and callee are using it.
334 "``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
335 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
336 the `High-Performance Erlang
337 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
338 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
339 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
340 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
341 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
342 convention properly supports `tail call
343 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
344 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
345 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
346 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
347 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
349 "``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
350 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
351 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
352 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
353 platform's customary return register.
354 "``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
355 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
356 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
357 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
358 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
359 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
360 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
361 "``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
362 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
363 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
364 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
365 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
366 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
367 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
368 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
369 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
371 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
372 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
373 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
375 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
376 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
377 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
378 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
379 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
380 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
381 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
382 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
383 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
384 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
385 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
387 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
388 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
389 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
390 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
391 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
392 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
394 "``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
395 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
396 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
397 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
398 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
399 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
400 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
401 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
402 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
403 returned in callee-saved registers.
405 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
406 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
407 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
409 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
410 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
412 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
413 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
414 experimental at this time.
415 "``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
416 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
417 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
418 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
419 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
422 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
423 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
424 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
426 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
427 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
428 caller/callee-saved registers.
430 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
431 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
433 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
435 "``swiftcc``" - This calling convention is used for Swift language.
436 - On X86-64 RCX and R8 are available for additional integer returns, and
437 XMM2 and XMM3 are available for additional FP/vector returns.
438 - On iOS platforms, we use AAPCS-VFP calling convention.
439 "``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
440 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
441 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
442 calling conventions start at 64.
444 More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
445 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
448 .. _visibilitystyles:
453 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
456 "``default``" - Default style
457 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
458 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
459 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
460 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
461 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
462 linkage" in the language.
463 "``hidden``" - Hidden style
464 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
465 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
466 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
467 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
468 library) can reference it directly.
469 "``protected``" - Protected style
470 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
471 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
472 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
473 cannot be overridden by another module.
475 A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
483 All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
487 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
488 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
489 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
490 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
492 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
493 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
494 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
495 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
496 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
497 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
501 Thread Local Storage Models
502 ---------------------------
504 A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
505 not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
506 variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
507 TLS model may be specified:
510 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
512 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
514 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
516 If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
518 The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
519 Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
520 more information on under which circumstances the different models may
521 be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
522 model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
524 A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
525 the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
527 For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
528 flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
530 .. _runtime_preemption_model:
532 Runtime Preemption Specifiers
533 -----------------------------
535 Global variables, functions and aliases may have an optional runtime preemption
536 specifier. If a preemption specifier isn't given explicitly, then a
537 symbol is assumed to be ``dso_preemptable``.
540 Indicates that the function or variable may be replaced by a symbol from
541 outside the linkage unit at runtime.
544 The compiler may assume that a function or variable marked as ``dso_local``
545 will resolve to a symbol within the same linkage unit. Direct access will
546 be generated even if the definition is not within this compilation unit.
553 LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
554 types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
555 are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
556 to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
558 An example of an identified structure specification is:
562 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
564 Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
565 literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
569 Non-Integral Pointer Type
570 -------------------------
572 Note: non-integral pointer types are a work in progress, and they should be
573 considered experimental at this time.
575 LLVM IR optionally allows the frontend to denote pointers in certain address
576 spaces as "non-integral" via the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
577 Non-integral pointer types represent pointers that have an *unspecified* bitwise
578 representation; that is, the integral representation may be target dependent or
579 unstable (not backed by a fixed integer).
581 ``inttoptr`` instructions converting integers to non-integral pointer types are
582 ill-typed, and so are ``ptrtoint`` instructions converting values of
583 non-integral pointer types to integers. Vector versions of said instructions
584 are ill-typed as well.
591 Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
594 Global variable definitions must be initialized.
596 Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
597 case they don't have an initializer.
599 Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
600 to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified. If there
601 is a mismatch between the explicit or inferred section information for the
602 variable declaration and its definition the resulting behavior is undefined.
604 A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
605 the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
606 optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
607 section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
608 initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
611 LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
612 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
613 capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
614 program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
615 optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
616 units that do not include the definition.
618 As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
619 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
620 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
621 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
624 Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
625 that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
626 like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
627 initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
628 merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
629 whose address is significant.
631 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
632 not be significant within the module.
634 A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
635 numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
636 may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
637 instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
638 is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
640 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
641 target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
642 Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
645 External declarations may have an explicit section specified. Section
646 information is retained in LLVM IR for targets that make use of this
647 information. Attaching section information to an external declaration is an
648 assertion that its definition is located in the specified section. If the
649 definition is located in a different section, the behavior is undefined.
651 By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
652 variables defined within the module are not modified from their
653 initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
654 true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
655 module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
656 ``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
657 by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
659 An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
660 power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
661 alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
662 convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
663 to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
664 to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
665 case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
666 assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
667 iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
668 iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
670 Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
671 an optional :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`,
672 an optional :ref:`global attributes <glattrs>` and
673 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`.
675 Variables and aliases can have a
676 :ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
680 @<GlobalVarName> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility]
681 [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
682 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace]
683 [ExternallyInitialized]
684 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
685 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
686 [, align <Alignment>] (, !name !N)*
688 For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
689 with an initializer, section, and alignment:
693 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
695 The following example just declares a global variable
699 @G = external global i32
701 The following example defines a thread-local global with the
702 ``initialexec`` TLS model:
706 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
708 .. _functionstructure:
713 LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
714 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`runtime preemption
715 specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
716 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
717 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
718 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
719 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
720 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
721 attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
722 an optional address space, an optional section, an optional alignment,
723 an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
724 an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
725 an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
726 an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
727 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
728 an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
730 LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
731 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility style
732 <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, an
733 optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, an optional ``unnamed_addr``
734 or ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute, an optional address space, a return type,
735 an optional :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function name, a possibly
736 empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional :ref:`garbage
737 collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, and an optional
738 :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
740 A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
741 Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
742 (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
743 and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
744 function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
745 implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
746 unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
747 entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
748 then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
750 The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
751 immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
752 to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
753 the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
754 predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
756 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
757 target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
758 Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
760 An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
761 or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
762 by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
763 is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
764 alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
766 If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
767 be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
769 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
770 not be significant within the module.
772 If an explicit address space is not given, it will default to the program
773 address space from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
777 define [linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
779 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
780 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace] [fn Attrs]
781 [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]] [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant]
782 [prologue Constant] [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
784 The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
785 argument is of the following form:
789 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
797 Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
798 are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
800 Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
803 Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
804 :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional
805 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
806 <dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
810 @<Name> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
812 The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
813 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
814 might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
816 Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
817 the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
820 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
821 not be significant within the module.
823 Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
824 some can only be checked when producing an object file:
826 * The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
827 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
829 * No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
830 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
833 * No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
834 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
841 IFuncs, like as aliases, don't create any new data or func. They are just a new
842 symbol that dynamic linker resolves at runtime by calling a resolver function.
844 IFuncs have a name and a resolver that is a function called by dynamic linker
845 that returns address of another function associated with the name.
847 IFunc may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>` and an optional
848 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`.
852 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] ifunc <IFuncTy>, <ResolverTy>* @<Resolver>
860 Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
862 Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
863 specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
864 that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
865 aliasee computes to, if any.
867 Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
868 choose between keys in two different object files.
872 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
874 The selection kind must be one of the following:
877 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
879 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
882 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
884 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
886 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
889 Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs, and ELF and WebAssembly
890 only support ``any`` as a selection kind.
892 Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
893 the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
897 $foo = comdat largest
898 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
900 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
904 As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
910 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
913 In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
914 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
915 and another COMDAT section with selection kind
916 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
917 section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
919 There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
920 It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
922 The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
923 which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
924 Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
925 linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
926 if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
928 The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
935 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
936 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
938 From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
939 with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
940 COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
943 Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
944 create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
945 COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
946 in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
947 is supplied to `llc`).
949 .. _namedmetadatastructure:
954 Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
955 nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
956 operands for a named metadata.
958 #. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
959 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
960 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
961 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
965 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
970 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
977 The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
978 *parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
979 used to communicate additional information about the result or
980 parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
981 of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
982 parameter attributes can have the same function type.
984 Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
985 If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
990 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
991 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
992 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
994 Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
995 ``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
997 Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
1000 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1001 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
1002 ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
1004 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1005 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
1006 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
1007 the callee (for a return value).
1009 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
1010 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
1011 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
1012 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
1013 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
1016 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
1017 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
1018 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
1019 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
1020 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
1021 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
1022 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
1023 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
1024 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
1027 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
1028 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
1029 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
1030 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
1031 makes a target-specific assumption.
1037 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
1038 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
1039 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
1040 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
1041 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
1042 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
1044 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
1045 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
1046 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
1047 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
1048 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
1049 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
1050 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
1052 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
1053 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
1054 behavior is undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
1055 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
1056 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
1057 <int_stackrestore>`.
1059 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
1063 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
1064 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
1065 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
1066 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee not
1067 to trap and to be properly aligned. This is not a valid attribute
1073 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
1074 have the specified alignment.
1076 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
1077 ``byval`` attribute.
1082 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
1083 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
1084 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
1085 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
1086 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
1087 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
1088 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
1089 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
1091 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
1092 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
1094 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
1095 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1096 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1097 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1098 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1099 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1100 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1103 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1104 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
1105 attribute for return values. Addresses used in volatile operations
1106 are considered to be captured.
1111 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1112 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
1113 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1116 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
1117 value. This is a hint to the optimizer and code generator used when
1118 generating the caller, allowing value propagation, tail call optimization,
1119 and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not
1120 checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the
1121 function return type must be valid operands for the
1122 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a valid attribute for
1123 return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1126 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1127 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1128 checked or enforced by LLVM; if the parameter or return pointer is null,
1129 the behavior is undefined.
1131 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1132 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1133 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1134 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1135 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1136 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1137 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1138 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1139 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1140 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1142 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1143 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1144 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
1145 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
1146 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1147 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1148 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1149 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1150 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1151 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
1152 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
1153 pointer typed parameters.
1156 This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not
1157 a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one
1161 This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It
1162 can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a
1163 pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds
1164 to a ``swifterror`` parameter has to come from a ``swifterror`` alloca or
1165 the ``swifterror`` parameter of the caller. A ``swifterror`` value (either
1166 the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded and stored from, or used as
1167 a ``swifterror`` argument. This is not a valid attribute for return values
1168 and can only be applied to one parameter.
1170 These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
1171 ``swifterror`` variables by associating them with a specific register at
1172 call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change
1173 the calling convention, a function which uses the ``swifterror`` attribute
1174 on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.
1176 These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a ``swifterror`` argument
1177 does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that a
1178 ``swifterror`` alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
1182 Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1183 --------------------------------
1185 Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
1188 .. code-block:: llvm
1190 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1192 The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
1193 <builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
1194 strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
1195 named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
1196 garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
1197 which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
1204 Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1205 generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1206 The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1207 language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1208 available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1209 function pointer to be called.
1211 To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1212 function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
1213 index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
1214 the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1215 with a single ``i32``,
1217 .. code-block:: llvm
1219 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1221 The prefix data can be referenced as,
1223 .. code-block:: llvm
1225 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1226 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
1227 %b = load i32, i32* %a
1229 Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
1230 of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
1231 beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1232 of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1233 function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1234 function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1237 A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
1238 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1239 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1246 The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1247 be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1248 function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1250 To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
1251 have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
1252 bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1253 module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
1254 the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
1255 the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
1256 definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
1257 makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
1259 A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
1260 which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1262 .. code-block:: text
1264 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
1266 Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1267 which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
1268 x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1270 .. code-block:: text
1272 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1274 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
1276 A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
1277 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1278 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1282 Personality Function
1283 --------------------
1285 The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1286 to use for exception handling.
1293 Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1294 the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1295 functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1296 ``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1297 group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1299 An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1300 object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1301 to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1302 different groups are merged.
1304 Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1305 inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1307 .. code-block:: llvm
1309 ; Target-independent attributes:
1310 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
1312 ; Target-dependent attributes:
1313 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
1315 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1316 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1323 Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1324 a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1325 function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1326 attributes can have the same function type.
1328 Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1329 If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1332 .. code-block:: llvm
1334 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1335 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1336 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1337 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1340 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1341 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1342 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1344 ``allocsize(<EltSizeParam>[, <NumEltsParam>])``
1345 This attribute indicates that the annotated function will always return at
1346 least a given number of bytes (or null). Its arguments are zero-indexed
1347 parameter numbers; if one argument is provided, then it's assumed that at
1348 least ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam]`` bytes will be available at the
1349 returned pointer. If two are provided, then it's assumed that
1350 ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam] * CallSite.Args[NumEltsParam]`` bytes are
1351 available. The referenced parameters must be integer types. No assumptions
1352 are made about the contents of the returned block of memory.
1354 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1355 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1356 inlining size threshold for this caller.
1358 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1359 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
1360 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
1361 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
1364 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1365 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1366 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1369 In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be
1370 made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
1371 ``convergent``, and mark them with this attribute.
1373 The ``convergent`` attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke
1374 instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to
1375 this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values.
1376 For example, the intrinsic ``llvm.nvvm.barrier0`` is ``convergent``, so
1377 calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional
1380 When it appears on a call/invoke, the ``convergent`` attribute indicates
1381 that we should treat the call as though we're calling a convergent
1382 function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we
1383 may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.
1385 The optimizer may remove the ``convergent`` attribute on functions when it
1386 can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations.
1387 Similarly, the optimizer may remove ``convergent`` on calls/invokes when it
1388 can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.
1389 ``inaccessiblememonly``
1390 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
1391 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
1392 of ``readnone``. If the function reads or writes other memory, the
1393 behavior is undefined.
1394 ``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
1395 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
1396 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
1397 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly``. If the
1398 function reads or writes other memory, the behavior is undefined.
1400 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1401 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1402 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1405 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1406 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1407 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1408 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1409 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1410 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1411 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
1413 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1414 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
1415 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
1416 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
1418 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1419 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
1421 When this attribute is set to true, the jump tables and lookup tables that
1422 can be generated from a switch case lowering are disabled.
1424 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1425 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1426 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1427 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1428 and on function declarations and definitions.
1430 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1431 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1432 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1433 its parent function.
1435 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1436 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1437 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1438 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1439 call is dead after inlining.
1441 This attributes disables implicit floating-point instructions.
1443 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1444 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1445 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
1447 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1448 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1449 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
1451 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1452 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1453 ``indirect-tls-seg-refs``
1454 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use
1455 direct TLS access through segment registers, even if the
1456 target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1458 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1459 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1460 function ever does dynamically return.
1462 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1463 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1464 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
1466 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1467 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1468 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1469 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1470 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1471 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
1472 ``"null-pointer-is-valid"``
1473 If ``"null-pointer-is-valid"`` is set to ``"true"``, then ``null`` address
1474 in address-space 0 is considered to be a valid address for memory loads and
1475 stores. Any analysis or optimization should not treat dereferencing a
1476 pointer to ``null`` as undefined behavior in this function.
1477 Note: Comparing address of a global variable to ``null`` may still
1478 evaluate to false because of a limitation in querying this attribute inside
1479 constant expressions.
1481 This attribute indicates that this function should be optimized
1482 for maximum fuzzing signal.
1484 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1485 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1486 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
1487 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1488 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1489 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
1491 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1492 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
1493 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
1494 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
1496 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1497 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
1498 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1499 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
1500 ``"patchable-function"``
1501 This attribute tells the code generator that the code
1502 generated for this function needs to follow certain conventions that
1503 make it possible for a runtime function to patch over it later.
1504 The exact effect of this attribute depends on its string value,
1505 for which there currently is one legal possibility:
1507 * ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` - This style of patchable
1508 function is intended to support patching a function prologue to
1509 redirect control away from the function in a thread safe
1510 manner. It guarantees that the first instruction of the
1511 function will be large enough to accommodate a short jump
1512 instruction, and will be sufficiently aligned to allow being
1513 fully changed via an atomic compare-and-swap instruction.
1514 While the first requirement can be satisfied by inserting large
1515 enough NOP, LLVM can and will try to re-purpose an existing
1516 instruction (i.e. one that would have to be emitted anyway) as
1517 the patchable instruction larger than a short jump.
1519 ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` is currently only supported on
1522 This attribute by itself does not imply restrictions on
1523 inter-procedural optimizations. All of the semantic effects the
1524 patching may have to be separately conveyed via the linkage type.
1526 This attribute indicates that the function will trigger a guard region
1527 in the end of the stack. It ensures that accesses to the stack must be
1528 no further apart than the size of the guard region to a previous
1529 access of the stack. It takes one required string value, the name of
1530 the stack probing function that will be called.
1532 If a function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into
1533 a function with another ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, the resulting
1534 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the caller. If a
1535 function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into a
1536 function that has no ``"probe-stack"`` attribute at all, the resulting
1537 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the callee.
1539 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1540 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
1541 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1542 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1543 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1544 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1545 to callers. This means while it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1546 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods (since they write to memory), there may
1547 be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw exceptions without writing to LLVM
1550 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1551 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
1552 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
1554 If a readnone function reads or writes memory visible to the program, or
1555 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads from
1556 or writes to a readnone pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1558 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1559 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
1560 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1561 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1562 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1563 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1564 called with the same set of arguments and global state. This means while it
1565 cannot unwind exceptions by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing methods
1566 (since they write to memory), there may be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw
1567 exceptions without writing to LLVM visible memory.
1569 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1570 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1571 the pointer points to.
1573 If a readonly function writes memory visible to the program, or
1574 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function writes to
1575 a readonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1576 ``"stack-probe-size"``
1577 This attribute controls the behavior of stack probes: either
1578 the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, or ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1579 It defines the size of the guard region. It ensures that if the function
1580 may use more stack space than the size of the guard region, stack probing
1581 sequence will be emitted. It takes one required integer value, which
1584 If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is inlined into
1585 a function with another ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute, the resulting
1586 function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute that has the lower
1587 numeric value. If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is
1588 inlined into a function that has no ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1589 at all, the resulting function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1591 ``"no-stack-arg-probe"``
1592 This attribute disables ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1594 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1595 does not read from memory.
1597 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1598 does not read through this pointer argument (even though it may read from
1599 the memory that the pointer points to).
1601 If a writeonly function reads memory visible to the program, or
1602 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads
1603 from a writeonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1605 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1606 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1607 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1608 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1611 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1612 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
1614 If an argmemonly function reads or writes memory other than the pointer
1615 arguments, or has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined.
1617 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1618 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1619 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1622 This attribute indicates that
1623 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1624 protection is enabled for this function.
1626 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1627 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1628 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1629 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
1630 ``sanitize_address``
1631 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1632 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1634 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1635 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1637 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1638 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1639 ``sanitize_hwaddress``
1640 This attribute indicates that HWAddressSanitizer checks
1641 (dynamic address safety analysis based on tagged pointers) are enabled for
1643 ``speculative_load_hardening``
1644 This attribute indicates that
1645 `Speculative Load Hardening <https://llvm.org/docs/SpeculativeLoadHardening.html>`_
1646 should be enabled for the function body.
1648 Speculative Load Hardening is a best-effort mitigation against
1649 information leak attacks that make use of control flow
1650 miss-speculation - specifically miss-speculation of whether a branch
1651 is taken or not. Typically vulnerabilities enabling such attacks are
1652 classified as "Spectre variant #1". Notably, this does not attempt to
1653 mitigate against miss-speculation of branch target, classified as
1654 "Spectre variant #2" vulnerabilities.
1656 When inlining, the attribute is sticky. Inlining a function that carries
1657 this attribute will cause the caller to gain the attribute. This is intended
1658 to provide a maximally conservative model where the code in a function
1659 annotated with this attribute will always (even after inlining) end up
1662 This function attribute indicates that the function does not have any
1663 effects besides calculating its result and does not have undefined behavior.
1664 Note that ``speculatable`` is not enough to conclude that along any
1665 particular execution path the number of calls to this function will not be
1666 externally observable. This attribute is only valid on functions
1667 and declarations, not on individual call sites. If a function is
1668 incorrectly marked as speculatable and really does exhibit
1669 undefined behavior, the undefined behavior may be observed even
1670 if the call site is dead code.
1673 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
1674 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
1675 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1676 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1677 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
1678 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
1680 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1681 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1682 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1683 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1685 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1686 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1688 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1689 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1690 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1692 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1693 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1696 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1697 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1698 The specific layout rules are:
1700 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1701 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1702 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1703 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1704 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1707 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1708 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
1709 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1710 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1712 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
1713 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
1714 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
1715 will enable protectors for functions with:
1717 - Arrays of any size and type
1718 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1719 - Calls to alloca().
1720 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1722 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1723 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1724 The specific layout rules are:
1726 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1727 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1728 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1729 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1730 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1733 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
1735 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1736 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1737 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
1739 This attribute indicates that the function was called from a scope that
1740 requires strict floating-point semantics. LLVM will not attempt any
1741 optimizations that require assumptions about the floating-point rounding
1742 mode or that might alter the state of floating-point status flags that
1743 might otherwise be set or cleared by calling this function.
1745 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1746 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1747 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1748 match the thunk target prototype.
1750 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
1751 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
1752 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1753 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1756 This attribute indicates that no control-flow check will be performed on
1757 the attributed entity. It disables -fcf-protection=<> for a specific
1758 entity to fine grain the HW control flow protection mechanism. The flag
1759 is target independent and currently appertains to a function or function
1762 This attribute indicates that the ShadowCallStack checks are enabled for
1763 the function. The instrumentation checks that the return address for the
1764 function has not changed between the function prolog and eiplog. It is
1765 currently x86_64-specific.
1772 Attributes may be set to communicate additional information about a global variable.
1773 Unlike :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`, attributes on a global variable
1774 are grouped into a single :ref:`attribute group <attrgrp>`.
1781 Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
1782 with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1783 ``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
1784 incorrect and will change program semantics.
1788 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
1789 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1790 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1791 tag ::= string constant
1793 Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1794 given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1795 of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1796 are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1797 callee being dispatched to.
1799 Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1800 runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1801 the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1802 there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1803 bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1804 are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1805 long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1806 restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1807 operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1809 - The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1810 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1811 - Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1812 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
1813 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overridden with
1814 callsite specific attributes.
1815 - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1816 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1817 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
1819 More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1821 .. _deopt_opbundles:
1823 Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1824 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1826 Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
1827 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1828 "safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1829 used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
1830 specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1831 bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1832 out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1833 rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
1835 From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1836 the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1837 through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1838 otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1839 operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1840 deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1843 The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1844 operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1845 involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1846 through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1847 appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1848 inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1849 continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1850 E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1852 .. code-block:: llvm
1855 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1856 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1857 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1862 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1868 .. code-block:: llvm
1871 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1872 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1873 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1877 It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1878 deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1879 caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1880 semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1881 continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1885 Funclet Operand Bundles
1886 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1888 Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
1889 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
1890 is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
1891 ``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
1892 exactly one bundle operand.
1894 If any funclet EH pads have been "entered" but not "exited" (per the
1895 `description in the EH doc\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
1896 it is undefined behavior to execute a ``call`` or ``invoke`` which:
1898 * does not have a ``"funclet"`` bundle and is not a ``call`` to a nounwind
1900 * has a ``"funclet"`` bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered
1901 not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
1903 Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
1904 executing a ``call`` or ``invoke`` with a ``"funclet"`` bundle is undefined behavior.
1906 GC Transition Operand Bundles
1907 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1909 GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
1910 ``"gc-transition"`` operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
1911 call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
1912 function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
1913 between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
1914 site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
1915 generated code. For more details, see :ref:`GC Transitions
1916 <gc_transition_args>`.
1920 Module-Level Inline Assembly
1921 ----------------------------
1923 Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1924 to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1925 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1926 in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1928 .. code-block:: llvm
1930 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1931 module asm "more can go here"
1933 The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1934 characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1935 two digit hex code for the number.
1937 Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1938 (unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
1940 .. _langref_datalayout:
1945 A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1946 how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1949 .. code-block:: llvm
1951 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1953 The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1954 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1955 with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1956 define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1960 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1961 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1964 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1965 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1968 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1969 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1970 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1971 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1972 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1973 alignment promotions.
1974 ``P<address space>``
1975 Specifies the address space that corresponds to program memory.
1976 Harvard architectures can use this to specify what space LLVM
1977 should place things such as functions into. If omitted, the
1978 program memory space defaults to the default address space of 0,
1979 which corresponds to a Von Neumann architecture that has code
1980 and data in the same space.
1981 ``A<address space>``
1982 Specifies the address space of objects created by '``alloca``'.
1983 Defaults to the default address space of 0.
1984 ``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>:<idx>``
1985 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
1986 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. The fourth parameter
1987 ``<idx>`` is a size of index that used for address calculation. If not
1988 specified, the default index size is equal to the pointer size. All sizes
1989 are in bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
1990 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
1991 in the range [1,2^23).
1992 ``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1993 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
1994 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
1995 ``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1996 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
1998 ``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1999 This specifies the alignment for a floating-point type of a given bit
2000 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
2001 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
2002 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
2005 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
2007 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. Symbols
2008 prefixed with the mangling escape character ``\01`` are passed through
2009 directly to the assembler without the escape character. The mangling style
2012 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
2013 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
2014 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
2015 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
2016 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF mangling: Private symbols get the usual prefix.
2017 Regular C symbols get a ``_`` prefix. Functions with ``__stdcall``,
2018 ``__fastcall``, and ``__vectorcall`` have custom mangling that appends
2019 ``@N`` where N is the number of bytes used to pass parameters. C++ symbols
2020 starting with ``?`` are not mangled in any way.
2021 * ``w``: Windows COFF mangling: Similar to ``x``, except that normal C
2022 symbols do not receive a ``_`` prefix.
2023 ``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
2024 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
2025 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
2026 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
2027 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
2029 ``ni:<address space0>:<address space1>:<address space2>...``
2030 This specifies pointer types with the specified address spaces
2031 as :ref:`Non-Integral Pointer Type <nointptrtype>` s. The ``0``
2032 address space cannot be specified as non-integral.
2034 On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
2035 ``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
2036 should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
2038 When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
2039 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
2040 the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
2041 specifications are given in this list:
2043 - ``E`` - big endian
2044 - ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
2045 - ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
2046 same as the default address space.
2047 - ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
2048 - ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2049 - ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2050 - ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
2051 - ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
2052 - ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
2053 alignment of 64-bits
2054 - ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
2055 - ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
2056 - ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
2057 - ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
2058 - ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
2059 - ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
2060 - ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
2062 When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
2065 #. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
2066 that specification is used.
2067 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
2068 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
2069 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
2070 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
2071 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
2072 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
2073 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
2074 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
2075 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
2076 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
2077 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
2079 The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
2080 Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
2081 the code generator should use.
2083 Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
2084 the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
2085 mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
2086 what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
2087 that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
2088 don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
2089 generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
2090 accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
2091 these default specifications.
2098 A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
2099 host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
2101 .. code-block:: llvm
2103 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
2105 The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
2106 by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
2110 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
2111 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
2113 This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
2114 code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
2115 command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
2117 .. _pointeraliasing:
2119 Pointer Aliasing Rules
2120 ----------------------
2122 Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
2123 an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
2124 undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
2125 to the following rules:
2127 - A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
2128 value it is *based* on.
2129 - An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
2130 of the variable's storage.
2131 - The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
2132 address range of the allocated storage.
2133 - A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
2135 - An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
2136 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
2137 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
2138 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
2139 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
2141 A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
2144 - A pointer value formed from a scalar ``getelementptr`` operation is *based* on
2145 the pointer-typed operand of the ``getelementptr``.
2146 - The pointer in lane *l* of the result of a vector ``getelementptr`` operation
2147 is *based* on the pointer in lane *l* of the vector-of-pointers-typed operand
2148 of the ``getelementptr``.
2149 - The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
2151 - A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
2152 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
2153 the pointer's value.
2154 - The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
2156 Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
2157 definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
2159 LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
2160 ``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
2161 which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
2162 operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
2163 alignment of the store.
2165 Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
2166 ``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
2167 :ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
2168 which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
2173 Volatile Memory Accesses
2174 ------------------------
2176 Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
2177 :ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
2178 marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
2179 volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
2180 volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
2181 operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
2182 "volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
2184 A volatile load or store may have additional target-specific semantics.
2185 Any volatile operation can have side effects, and any volatile operation
2186 can read and/or modify state which is not accessible via a regular load
2187 or store in this module. Volatile operations may use addresses which do
2188 not point to memory (like MMIO registers). This means the compiler may
2189 not use a volatile operation to prove a non-volatile access to that
2190 address has defined behavior.
2192 The allowed side-effects for volatile accesses are limited. If a
2193 non-volatile store to a given address would be legal, a volatile
2194 operation may modify the memory at that address. A volatile operation
2195 may not modify any other memory accessible by the module being compiled.
2196 A volatile operation may not call any code in the current module.
2198 The compiler may assume execution will continue after a volatile operation,
2199 so operations which modify memory or may have undefined behavior can be
2200 hoisted past a volatile operation.
2202 IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
2203 llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
2204 flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
2205 target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
2207 .. admonition:: Rationale
2209 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
2210 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
2211 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
2212 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
2213 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
2214 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
2215 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
2219 Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
2220 --------------------------------------
2222 The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
2223 execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
2224 platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
2225 in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
2227 For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
2229 We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
2232 - Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
2233 - When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
2234 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
2235 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
2236 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
2237 Constraints <ordering>`).
2239 Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
2240 between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
2242 Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
2243 loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
2244 (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
2245 stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
2246 section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
2247 initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
2248 of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
2249 may see any write to the same byte, except:
2251 - If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
2252 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
2253 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
2254 - If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
2255 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
2257 Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
2259 - If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
2260 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
2261 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
2262 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
2264 - Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
2265 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
2266 - Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
2267 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
2268 - Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
2269 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
2270 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
2271 constraints on how the choice is made.
2272 - Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
2274 R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
2275 implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
2276 the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
2277 semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
2278 than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
2280 Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
2281 model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
2282 is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
2283 which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
2284 (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
2285 from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
2286 exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
2290 Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
2291 ----------------------------------
2293 Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
2294 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
2295 :ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
2296 ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
2297 the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
2298 from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
2299 descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
2300 references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
2301 :ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
2302 differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
2303 documentation for details.
2305 For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
2309 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
2310 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
2311 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
2312 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
2313 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
2314 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
2316 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
2317 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
2318 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
2319 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
2320 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
2321 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
2322 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
2323 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
2324 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
2325 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
2326 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
2327 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
2328 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
2329 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
2330 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
2331 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2332 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
2334 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
2335 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
2336 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
2338 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
2339 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
2340 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
2341 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
2342 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2343 ``memory_order_release``.
2344 ``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
2345 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
2346 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
2347 ``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
2348 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
2349 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
2350 writes), there is a global total order on all
2351 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
2352 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
2353 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
2354 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
2355 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2356 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
2360 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``, it only
2361 *synchronizes with* and only participates in the seq\_cst total orderings of
2362 other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal handlers).
2364 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``, where
2365 ``<target-scope>`` is a target specific synchronization scope, then it is target
2366 dependent if it *synchronizes with* and participates in the seq\_cst total
2367 orderings of other operations.
2369 Otherwise, an atomic operation that is not marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``
2370 or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` *synchronizes with* and participates in the
2371 seq\_cst total orderings of other operations that are not marked
2372 ``syncscope("singlethread")`` or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``.
2376 Floating-Point Environment
2377 --------------------------
2379 The default LLVM floating-point environment assumes that floating-point
2380 instructions do not have side effects. Results assume the round-to-nearest
2381 rounding mode. No floating-point exception state is maintained in this
2382 environment. Therefore, there is no attempt to create or preserve invalid
2383 operation (SNaN) or division-by-zero exceptions.
2385 The benefit of this exception-free assumption is that floating-point
2386 operations may be speculated freely without any other fast-math relaxations
2387 to the floating-point model.
2389 Code that requires different behavior than this should use the
2390 :ref:`Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics <constrainedfp>`.
2397 LLVM IR floating-point operations (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
2398 :ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
2399 :ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) and :ref:`call <i_call>`
2400 may use the following flags to enable otherwise unsafe
2401 floating-point transformations.
2404 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2405 NaN. If an argument is a nan, or the result would be a nan, it produces
2406 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2409 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2410 +/-Inf. If an argument is +/-Inf, or the result would be +/-Inf, it
2411 produces a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2414 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2415 argument or result as insignificant.
2418 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2419 argument rather than perform division.
2422 Allow floating-point contraction (e.g. fusing a multiply followed by an
2423 addition into a fused multiply-and-add).
2426 Approximate functions - Allow substitution of approximate calculations for
2427 functions (sin, log, sqrt, etc). See floating-point intrinsic definitions
2428 for places where this can apply to LLVM's intrinsic math functions.
2431 Allow reassociation transformations for floating-point instructions.
2432 This may dramatically change results in floating-point.
2435 This flag implies all of the others.
2439 Use-list Order Directives
2440 -------------------------
2442 Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
2443 order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2444 indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
2445 value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2447 Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2448 instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
2449 function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2451 If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2452 ``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2459 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2460 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2466 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2468 ; ... instructions ...
2470 ; ... instructions ...
2472 ; At function scope.
2473 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2474 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2478 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2479 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2480 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2481 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2483 .. _source_filename:
2488 The *source filename* string is set to the original module identifier,
2489 which will be the name of the compiled source file when compiling from
2490 source through the clang front end, for example. It is then preserved through
2493 This is currently necessary to generate a consistent unique global
2494 identifier for local functions used in profile data, which prepends the
2495 source file name to the local function name.
2497 The syntax for the source file name is simply:
2499 .. code-block:: text
2501 source_filename = "/path/to/source.c"
2508 The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2509 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2510 optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2511 directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2512 transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2513 generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2514 not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2524 The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2542 The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2543 return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2544 type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2545 and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
2551 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
2553 ...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2554 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
2555 indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
2556 argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
2557 handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
2558 except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
2562 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2563 | ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2564 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2565 | ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2566 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2567 | ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2568 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2569 | ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2570 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2577 The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2578 Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2586 These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
2595 The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2596 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2597 bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2605 The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2611 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2612 | ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2613 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2614 | ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2615 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2616 | ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2617 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2621 Floating-Point Types
2622 """"""""""""""""""""
2631 - 16-bit floating-point value
2634 - 32-bit floating-point value
2637 - 64-bit floating-point value
2640 - 128-bit floating-point value (112-bit mantissa)
2643 - 80-bit floating-point value (X87)
2646 - 128-bit floating-point value (two 64-bits)
2648 The binary format of half, float, double, and fp128 correspond to the
2649 IEEE-754-2008 specifications for binary16, binary32, binary64, and binary128
2657 The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
2658 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2659 return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2660 instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2661 and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2678 The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2679 commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2681 Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2682 numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2683 address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2684 are target-specific.
2686 Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2687 permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
2697 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2698 | ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2699 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2700 | ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2701 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2702 | ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2703 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2712 A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2713 elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2714 operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2715 requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
2716 type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2722 < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
2724 The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
2725 elementtype may be any integer, floating-point or pointer type. Vectors
2726 of size zero are not allowed.
2730 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2731 | ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2732 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2733 | ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2734 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2735 | ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2736 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2737 | ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2738 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2747 The label type represents code labels.
2762 The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2763 but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2764 As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2765 :ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2782 The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2783 created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2796 Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2797 member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2798 aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2808 The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2809 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2810 elements) and an underlying data type.
2816 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2818 The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2819 be any type with a size.
2823 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2824 | ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2825 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2826 | ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2827 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2828 | ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2829 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2831 Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2833 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2834 | ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2835 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2836 | ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating-point values. |
2837 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2838 | ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2839 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2841 There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2842 by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2843 bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2844 single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2845 LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2846 arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2856 The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2857 together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2860 Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2861 getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2862 Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2863 '``insertvalue``' instructions.
2865 Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2866 the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2867 between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2868 is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2869 required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2871 Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2872 is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2873 identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2874 Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2875 or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2876 recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2882 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2883 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2887 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2888 | ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2889 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2890 | ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
2891 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2892 | ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2893 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2897 Opaque Structure Types
2898 """"""""""""""""""""""
2902 Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2903 do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2904 notion of a forward declared structure.
2915 +--------------+-------------------+
2916 | ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2917 +--------------+-------------------+
2924 LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2925 describes them all and their syntax.
2930 **Boolean constants**
2931 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2933 **Integer constants**
2934 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2935 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2937 **Floating-point constants**
2938 Floating-point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
2939 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2940 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2941 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2942 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
2943 decimal in binary. Floating-point constants must have a
2944 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type.
2945 **Null pointer constants**
2946 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2947 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
2949 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
2950 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
2952 The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
2953 floating-point constants. For example, the form
2954 '``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
2955 than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating-point
2956 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
2957 disassembler) is when a floating-point constant must be emitted but it
2958 cannot be represented as a decimal floating-point number in a reasonable
2959 number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2960 values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2961 and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2963 When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2964 double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2965 matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
2966 must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
2967 precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
2968 double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
2969 by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
2970 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
2971 ``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
2972 represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
2973 will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
2974 The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
2975 followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
2976 (sign bit at the left).
2978 There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
2980 .. _complexconstants:
2985 Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
2986 constants and smaller complex constants.
2988 **Structure constants**
2989 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
2990 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
2991 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
2992 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
2993 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
2994 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
2995 must match those specified by the type.
2997 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
2998 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2999 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
3000 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
3001 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
3002 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
3003 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
3004 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
3005 **Vector constants**
3006 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
3007 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
3008 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
3009 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
3010 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
3011 elements must match those specified by the type.
3012 **Zero initialization**
3013 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
3014 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
3015 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
3016 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
3017 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
3019 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
3020 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
3021 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
3022 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
3023 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
3024 information such as debug info.
3026 Global Variable and Function Addresses
3027 --------------------------------------
3029 The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
3030 :ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
3031 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
3032 the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
3033 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
3036 .. code-block:: llvm
3040 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
3047 The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
3048 indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
3049 bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
3050 or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
3052 Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
3053 the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
3054 compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
3055 (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
3057 .. code-block:: llvm
3067 This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
3068 bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
3070 .. code-block:: llvm
3078 %A = %X ;; By choosing undef as 0
3079 %B = %X ;; By choosing undef as -1
3084 These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
3085 input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
3086 '``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
3087 the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
3088 optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
3089 However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
3090 0, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
3091 all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
3092 allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
3094 .. code-block:: llvm
3096 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
3097 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
3098 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
3108 This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
3109 branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
3110 of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
3111 both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
3112 cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
3113 allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
3114 ``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
3116 .. code-block:: text
3118 %A = xor undef, undef
3135 This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
3136 necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
3137 C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
3138 ``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
3139 short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
3140 its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
3141 doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
3142 read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
3143 the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
3144 ``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
3145 uses with" concept would not hold.
3147 .. code-block:: llvm
3155 These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
3156 and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
3157 allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
3158 operation can be constant folded to '``0``', because the '``undef``'
3159 could be zero, and zero divided by any value is zero.
3160 However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
3161 assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
3162 we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
3163 has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
3164 does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
3165 code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
3166 optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
3168 .. code-block:: text
3170 a: store undef -> %X
3171 b: store %X -> undef
3176 A store *of* an undefined value can be assumed to not have any effect;
3177 we can assume that the value is overwritten with bits that happen to
3178 match what was already there. However, a store *to* an undefined
3179 location could clobber arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined
3187 Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
3188 they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
3189 that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
3190 that results in undefined behavior.
3192 There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
3193 only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
3196 Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
3198 - Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
3199 - :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
3200 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
3201 - Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
3202 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
3203 - :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
3204 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3205 - :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
3206 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
3207 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3208 - Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
3209 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
3210 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
3211 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
3212 - An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
3213 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
3214 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
3215 operations <volatile>`.)
3216 - An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
3217 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
3218 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
3219 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
3220 when control is transferred to another.
3221 - Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
3222 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
3223 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
3225 - Dependence is transitive.
3227 Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
3228 with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
3229 on a poison value has undefined behavior.
3231 Here are some examples:
3233 .. code-block:: llvm
3236 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
3237 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
3238 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
3239 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
3241 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
3242 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
3244 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
3246 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
3247 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
3248 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3249 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3251 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
3252 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
3255 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
3256 ; it has undefined behavior.
3260 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
3261 ; Both edges into this PHI are
3262 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
3263 ; always results in a poison value.
3265 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
3266 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
3267 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
3269 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
3270 ; The same branch again, but this time the
3271 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
3278 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
3279 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
3280 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
3281 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
3282 ; behavior in this example).
3286 Addresses of Basic Blocks
3287 -------------------------
3289 ``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
3291 The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
3292 basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
3293 Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
3295 This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
3296 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
3297 against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
3298 undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
3299 no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
3300 opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
3301 allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
3302 long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
3305 Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
3306 as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
3310 Constant Expressions
3311 --------------------
3313 Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
3314 constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
3315 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
3316 that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
3317 The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
3319 ``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
3320 Perform the :ref:`trunc operation <i_trunc>` on constants.
3321 ``zext (CST to TYPE)``
3322 Perform the :ref:`zext operation <i_zext>` on constants.
3323 ``sext (CST to TYPE)``
3324 Perform the :ref:`sext operation <i_sext>` on constants.
3325 ``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
3326 Truncate a floating-point constant to another floating-point type.
3327 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
3328 must be floating-point.
3329 ``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
3330 Floating-point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
3331 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
3333 ``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
3334 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding unsigned
3335 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3336 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3337 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3338 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3339 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3340 ``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
3341 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding signed
3342 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3343 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3344 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3345 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3346 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3347 ``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3348 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding
3349 floating-point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point
3350 type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3351 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3352 ``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3353 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating-point
3354 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point type.
3355 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3356 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3357 ``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
3358 Perform the :ref:`ptrtoint operation <i_ptrtoint>` on constants.
3359 ``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
3360 Perform the :ref:`inttoptr operation <i_inttoptr>` on constants.
3361 This one is *really* dangerous!
3362 ``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
3363 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE.
3364 The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the
3365 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`.
3366 ``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
3367 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
3368 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
3369 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
3370 ``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3371 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
3372 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
3373 instruction, the index list may have one or more indexes, which are
3374 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
3375 ``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
3376 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
3377 ``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3378 Perform the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
3379 ``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3380 Perform the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
3381 ``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
3382 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
3384 ``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
3385 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
3387 ``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
3388 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
3390 ``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3391 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
3392 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
3393 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
3394 least one index value must be specified.
3395 ``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3396 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
3397 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
3398 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
3399 value must be specified.
3400 ``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
3401 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
3402 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
3403 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
3404 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
3405 operations on floating-point values are allowed).
3412 Inline Assembler Expressions
3413 ----------------------------
3415 LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
3416 Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
3417 represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
3418 instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
3419 flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
3420 and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
3421 stack conservatively.
3423 The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
3424 followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
3425 location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
3426 be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
3427 operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
3429 A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
3430 other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
3431 used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
3432 resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
3433 disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
3434 syntax known to LLVM.
3436 LLVM also supports a few more substitions useful for writing inline assembly:
3438 - ``${:uid}``: Expands to a decimal integer unique to this inline assembly blob.
3439 This substitution is useful when declaring a local label. Many standard
3440 compiler optimizations, such as inlining, may duplicate an inline asm blob.
3441 Adding a blob-unique identifier ensures that the two labels will not conflict
3442 during assembly. This is used to implement `GCC's %= special format
3443 string <https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Extended-Asm.html>`_.
3444 - ``${:comment}``: Expands to the comment character of the current target's
3445 assembly dialect. This is usually ``#``, but many targets use other strings,
3446 such as ``;``, ``//``, or ``!``.
3447 - ``${:private}``: Expands to the assembler private label prefix. Labels with
3448 this prefix will not appear in the symbol table of the assembled object.
3449 Typically the prefix is ``L``, but targets may use other strings. ``.L`` is
3452 LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
3453 GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
3454 modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
3455 support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
3456 described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
3457 while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
3458 translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
3461 An example inline assembler expression is:
3463 .. code-block:: llvm
3465 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3467 Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3468 of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3469 Thus, typically we have:
3471 .. code-block:: llvm
3473 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3475 Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3476 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3477 '``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3479 .. code-block:: llvm
3481 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3483 In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3484 the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3485 x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3486 The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3487 might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3488 prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3490 .. code-block:: llvm
3492 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3494 Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3495 assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3496 the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3497 the only supported dialects. An example is:
3499 .. code-block:: llvm
3501 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3503 If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3504 first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3507 Inline Asm Constraint String
3508 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3510 The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3511 more constraint codes.
3513 For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3514 operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3515 string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3518 There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3519 prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3520 constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3521 clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3523 There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3525 - Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3526 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3527 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3528 - Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3529 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3530 modes used by the target.
3531 - Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3532 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3533 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3534 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3539 Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3540 indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3541 then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3542 constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3543 below about indirect outputs).
3545 Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3546 expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3547 the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3548 assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3549 the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3550 modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
3551 "early-clobber" output. Marking an output as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
3552 will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3558 Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3559 constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3560 permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3561 that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3562 assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3563 contain the same value.
3565 Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3566 themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3567 string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3568 take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3569 be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3570 to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3571 output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3574 It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3575 *other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3576 (even when the other input has the same value).
3578 You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3579 memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3581 There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3582 register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3583 type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3584 registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3586 However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3588 Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3589 architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3590 instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3591 SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3592 hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3593 feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3595 A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3596 to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3597 ``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3598 register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3599 probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3600 clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3601 despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3604 Indirect inputs and outputs
3605 """""""""""""""""""""""""""
3607 Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3608 (which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3609 will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3610 argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3611 an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3612 rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3613 "output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3614 memory location, instead of just read from it).
3616 This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3617 address of a variable as a value.
3619 It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3620 (e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3621 value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3622 input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3623 functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3624 statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3625 optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3631 A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3632 consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3633 general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3634 constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3635 "``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3636 memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3639 Note that clobbering named registers that are also present in output
3640 constraints is not legal.
3645 After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3647 A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3648 followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3651 The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3652 GCC's constraint codes.
3654 A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3655 it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3656 compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3658 There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3659 inline asm constraint list:
3661 1) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3662 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3663 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3666 2) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3667 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3668 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3669 constraint list will be chosen together.
3671 Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3672 ``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3673 operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3674 may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3676 However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3677 LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3678 point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3679 in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3680 compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3681 always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3682 or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3683 doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3684 unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3685 ``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3688 Supported Constraint Code List
3689 """"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3691 The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3692 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3693 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3694 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3696 Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3698 - ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3699 - ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3700 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3701 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3702 - ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3703 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3704 - ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3705 - ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3706 - ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3707 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3709 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3710 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3712 - ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3714 Other constraints are target-specific:
3718 - ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3719 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3720 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3721 - ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3722 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3723 - ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3724 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3725 - ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3726 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3727 - ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3728 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3729 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3730 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3731 - ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3732 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3733 - ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3734 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3736 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3737 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3738 - ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3742 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3743 - ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3744 - ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3749 - ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3750 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3752 ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3754 - ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3755 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3756 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3757 - ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3758 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3759 print the inverted value).
3760 - ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3761 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3763 - ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3764 - ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3765 - ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3766 - ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3767 - ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3769 - ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3771 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3772 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3773 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3774 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3775 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3780 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3781 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3782 - ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3784 - ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3785 - ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3786 - ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3787 - ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3788 - ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3789 - ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3790 - ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3791 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3792 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3793 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3794 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3795 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3801 - ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3803 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3807 - ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3811 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3812 - ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3813 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3814 - ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3815 - ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3816 - ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3817 - ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3818 - ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3819 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3820 - ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3821 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3823 - ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3824 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3825 - ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3826 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
3827 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3828 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
3829 - ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3831 - ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3836 - ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3837 - ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3838 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3839 - ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3840 - ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3841 - ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3846 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3847 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3848 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3849 - ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3850 - ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3851 - ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3852 - ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3853 - ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3855 - ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3856 treated the same as ``m``.
3857 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3858 - ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3860 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3861 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3862 - ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3863 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3864 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3866 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3867 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3869 - ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3870 - ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3871 - ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3872 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3873 - ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating-point register, from the full VSX register
3878 - ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3879 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3880 - ``f``: Any floating-point register on SparcV8, or a floating-point
3881 register in the "low" half of the registers on SparcV9.
3882 - ``e``: Any floating-point register. (Same as ``f`` on SparcV8.)
3886 - ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3887 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3888 - ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3889 - ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3890 - ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
3891 - ``Q``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 12-bit immediate
3892 unsigned displacement.
3893 - ``R``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 12-bit immediate
3894 unsigned displacement, and an index register.
3895 - ``S``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 20-bit immediate
3896 signed displacement.
3897 - ``T``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 20-bit immediate
3898 signed displacement, and an index register.
3899 - ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3900 - ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3901 address context evaluates as zero).
3902 - ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3904 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point register.
3908 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3909 - ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3910 - ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3911 - ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3913 - ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3914 - ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3915 - ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3916 - ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3917 - ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3918 - ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3919 - ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3920 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3921 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3922 - ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3923 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3924 - ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3925 - ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3926 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3927 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3928 - ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3929 - ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3930 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3931 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3932 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3933 - ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3934 - ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3935 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3936 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3937 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3938 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3943 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3946 .. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3948 Asm template argument modifiers
3949 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3951 In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3954 The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3955 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3956 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3957 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3961 - ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
3962 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3963 - ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3964 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3965 - ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
3966 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3970 - ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
3971 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
3972 - ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
3973 - ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
3974 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
3983 - ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
3987 - ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
3988 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
3989 - ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
3991 - ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
3992 - ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
3993 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
3994 - ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
3995 register of a two-register operand.
3996 - ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
3997 register of a two-register operand.
3998 - ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
3999 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
4002 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
4003 of a two-register operand.
4005 - ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
4006 - ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
4007 - ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
4012 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4013 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4015 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4016 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4018 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4019 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4023 No additional modifiers.
4027 - ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
4028 - ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
4029 - ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
4030 - ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
4031 - ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
4032 - ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4033 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4035 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
4037 - ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4038 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4040 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
4042 - ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4043 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
4044 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
4046 - ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
4047 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
4056 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4057 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4059 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4060 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4062 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4063 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4064 - ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
4065 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
4066 - ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
4067 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
4068 always print nothing)
4069 - ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
4070 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
4078 SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
4079 target-independent modifiers.
4083 - ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
4084 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
4085 - ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
4086 - ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
4088 - ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
4090 - ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
4092 - ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
4094 - ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
4095 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
4096 - ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
4097 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
4098 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
4099 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
4100 - ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
4101 - ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
4102 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
4106 No additional modifiers.
4112 The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
4113 "``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
4114 integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
4115 location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
4116 error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
4117 errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
4120 .. code-block:: llvm
4122 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
4124 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
4126 It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
4127 in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
4128 will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
4136 LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
4137 that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
4138 code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
4139 debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
4141 Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
4142 ``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
4144 All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
4146 .. _metadata-string:
4148 Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
4149 -----------------------------------
4151 A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
4152 contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
4153 "``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
4156 Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
4157 constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
4158 preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
4159 their operand. For example:
4161 .. code-block:: llvm
4163 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
4165 Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
4167 .. code-block:: text
4169 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
4171 ``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
4172 content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
4173 when metadata operands change.
4175 A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
4176 metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
4179 .. code-block:: llvm
4183 Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here the ``llvm.dbg.value``
4184 intrinsic is using three metadata arguments:
4186 .. code-block:: llvm
4188 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, metadata !25, metadata !26)
4190 Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
4191 to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4193 .. code-block:: llvm
4195 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
4197 Metadata can also be attached to a function or a global variable. Here metadata
4198 ``!22`` is attached to the ``f1`` and ``f2 functions, and the globals ``g1``
4199 and ``g2`` using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4201 .. code-block:: llvm
4203 declare !dbg !22 void @f1()
4204 define void @f2() !dbg !22 {
4208 @g1 = global i32 0, !dbg !22
4209 @g2 = external global i32, !dbg !22
4211 A transformation is required to drop any metadata attachment that it does not
4212 know or know it can't preserve. Currently there is an exception for metadata
4213 attachment to globals for ``!type`` and ``!absolute_symbol`` which can't be
4214 unconditionally dropped unless the global is itself deleted.
4216 Metadata attached to a module using named metadata may not be dropped, with
4217 the exception of debug metadata (named metadata with the name ``!llvm.dbg.*``).
4219 More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
4220 optimizers and code generator is found below.
4222 .. _specialized-metadata:
4224 Specialized Metadata Nodes
4225 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4227 Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
4228 to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
4231 These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
4232 metadata nodes are related to debug info.
4239 ``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
4240 ``retainedTypes:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:`` fields are tuples
4241 containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile unit, regardless
4242 of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are references to
4243 them from instructions). The ``debugInfoForProfiling:`` field is a boolean
4244 indicating whether or not line-table discriminators are updated to provide
4245 more-accurate debug info for profiling results.
4247 .. code-block:: text
4249 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
4250 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
4251 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
4252 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, globals: !4, imports: !5,
4253 macros: !6, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
4255 Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
4256 specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope. These
4257 descriptors are collected by a named metadata node ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They keep
4258 track of global variables, type information, and imported entities (declarations
4266 ``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
4268 .. code-block:: none
4270 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir",
4271 checksumkind: CSK_MD5,
4272 checksum: "000102030405060708090a0b0c0d0e0f")
4274 Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
4275 for ``file:`` fields.
4276 Valid values for ``checksumkind:`` field are: {CSK_None, CSK_MD5, CSK_SHA1}
4283 ``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
4284 ``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
4286 .. code-block:: text
4288 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4289 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4290 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
4292 The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
4295 .. code-block:: text
4301 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
4303 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
4305 .. _DISubroutineType:
4310 ``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
4311 refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
4312 types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
4313 represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
4315 .. code-block:: text
4317 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
4318 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
4319 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
4326 ``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
4329 .. code-block:: text
4331 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4332 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4333 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
4336 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4338 .. code-block:: text
4341 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
4342 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
4344 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
4345 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
4346 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
4348 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
4349 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
4350 DW_TAG_atomic_type = 71
4352 .. _DIDerivedTypeMember:
4354 ``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
4355 <DICompositeType>`. The type of the member is the ``baseType:``. The
4356 ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. If the composite type has an ODR
4357 ``identifier:`` and does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``, then the member is
4358 uniqued based only on its ``name:`` and ``scope:``.
4360 ``DW_TAG_inheritance`` and ``DW_TAG_friend`` are used in the ``elements:``
4361 field of :ref:`composite types <DICompositeType>` to describe parents and
4364 ``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
4366 ``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
4367 ``DW_TAG_volatile_type``, ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` and ``DW_TAG_atomic_type``
4368 are used to qualify the ``baseType:``.
4370 Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
4372 .. _DICompositeType:
4377 ``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
4378 structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
4380 If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
4381 identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified,
4382 :ref:`subprogram declarations <DISubprogramDeclaration>` and :ref:`member
4383 derived types <DIDerivedTypeMember>` that reference the ODR-type in their
4384 ``scope:`` change uniquing rules.
4386 For a given ``identifier:``, there should only be a single composite type that
4387 does not have ``flags: DIFlagFwdDecl`` set. LLVM tools that link modules
4388 together will unique such definitions at parse time via the ``identifier:``
4389 field, even if the nodes are ``distinct``.
4391 .. code-block:: text
4393 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4394 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4395 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4396 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
4397 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
4398 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
4400 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4402 .. code-block:: text
4404 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
4405 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
4406 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
4407 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
4408 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
4410 For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
4411 descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
4412 level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
4413 array type is a native packed vector.
4415 For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
4416 descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
4417 value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
4418 ``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4420 For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
4421 ``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
4422 <DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member``, ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``, or
4423 ``tag: DW_TAG_friend``; or :ref:`subprograms <DISubprogram>` with
4424 ``isDefinition: false``.
4431 ``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
4432 :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4434 - ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
4435 - ``count: !9`` describes the count with a :ref:`DILocalVariable`.
4436 - ``count: !11`` describes the count with a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable`.
4438 .. code-block:: text
4440 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
4441 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
4442 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
4444 ; Scopes used in rest of example
4445 !6 = !DIFile(filename: "vla.c", directory: "/path/to/file")
4446 !7 = distinct !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !6)
4447 !8 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", scope: !7, file: !6, line: 5)
4449 ; Use of local variable as count value
4450 !9 = !DIBasicType(name: "int", size: 32, encoding: DW_ATE_signed)
4451 !10 = !DILocalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 42, type: !9)
4452 !11 = !DISubrange(count: !10, lowerBound: 0)
4454 ; Use of global variable as count value
4455 !12 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 22, type: !9)
4456 !13 = !DISubrange(count: !12, lowerBound: 0)
4463 ``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
4464 variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4466 .. code-block:: text
4468 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4469 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4470 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4472 DITemplateTypeParameter
4473 """""""""""""""""""""""
4475 ``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
4476 language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
4477 :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4479 .. code-block:: text
4481 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
4483 DITemplateValueParameter
4484 """"""""""""""""""""""""
4486 ``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
4487 language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
4488 but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
4489 ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
4490 :ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4492 .. code-block:: text
4494 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
4499 ``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
4501 .. code-block:: text
4503 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
4505 .. _DIGlobalVariable:
4510 ``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
4512 .. code-block:: text
4514 @foo = global i32, !dbg !0
4515 !0 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(var: !1, expr: !DIExpression())
4516 !1 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !2,
4517 file: !3, line: 7, type: !4, isLocal: true,
4518 isDefinition: false, declaration: !5)
4521 DIGlobalVariableExpression
4522 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
4524 ``DIGlobalVariableExpression`` nodes tie a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable` together
4525 with a :ref:`DIExpression`.
4527 .. code-block:: text
4529 @lower = global i32, !dbg !0
4530 @upper = global i32, !dbg !1
4531 !0 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(
4533 expr: !DIExpression(DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 0, 32)
4535 !1 = !DIGlobalVariableExpression(
4537 expr: !DIExpression(DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 32, 32)
4539 !2 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "split64", linkageName: "split64", scope: !3,
4540 file: !4, line: 8, type: !5, declaration: !6)
4542 All global variable expressions should be referenced by the `globals:` field of
4543 a :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4550 ``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4551 ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
4552 metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
4553 that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
4554 the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
4556 .. _DISubprogramDeclaration:
4558 When ``isDefinition: false``, subprograms describe a declaration in the type
4559 tree as opposed to a definition of a function. If the scope is a composite
4560 type with an ODR ``identifier:`` and that does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``,
4561 then the subprogram declaration is uniqued based only on its ``linkageName:``
4564 .. code-block:: text
4566 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4570 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4571 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4572 isDefinition: true, scopeLine: 8,
4574 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4575 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
4576 isOptimized: true, unit: !5, templateParams: !6,
4577 declaration: !7, variables: !8, thrownTypes: !9)
4584 ``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
4585 <DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
4586 two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
4589 .. code-block:: text
4591 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
4593 Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4596 .. _DILexicalBlockFile:
4601 ``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
4602 :ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
4603 indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4604 discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4606 .. code-block:: text
4608 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4609 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4610 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
4617 ``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
4618 mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4619 :ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4621 .. code-block:: text
4623 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
4625 .. _DILocalVariable:
4630 ``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
4631 the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4632 parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4633 :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4635 .. code-block:: text
4637 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4638 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4639 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4641 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
4648 ``DIExpression`` nodes represent expressions that are inspired by the DWARF
4649 expression language. They are used in :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>`
4650 (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare`` and ``llvm.dbg.value``) to describe how the
4651 referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language variable. Debug
4652 intrinsics are interpreted left-to-right: start by pushing the value/address
4653 operand of the intrinsic onto a stack, then repeatedly push and evaluate
4654 opcodes from the DIExpression until the final variable description is produced.
4656 The current supported opcode vocabulary is limited:
4658 - ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the top of the expression stack.
4659 - ``DW_OP_plus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, adds
4660 them together and appends the result to the expression stack.
4661 - ``DW_OP_minus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, subtracts
4662 the last entry from the second last entry and appends the result to the
4664 - ``DW_OP_plus_uconst, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
4665 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4666 here, respectively) of the variable fragment from the working expression. Note
4667 that contrary to DW_OP_bit_piece, the offset is describing the location
4668 within the described source variable.
4669 - ``DW_OP_swap`` swaps top two stack entries.
4670 - ``DW_OP_xderef`` provides extended dereference mechanism. The entry at the top
4671 of the stack is treated as an address. The second stack entry is treated as an
4672 address space identifier.
4673 - ``DW_OP_stack_value`` marks a constant value.
4675 DWARF specifies three kinds of simple location descriptions: Register, memory,
4676 and implicit location descriptions. Note that a location description is
4677 defined over certain ranges of a program, i.e the location of a variable may
4678 change over the course of the program. Register and memory location
4679 descriptions describe the *concrete location* of a source variable (in the
4680 sense that a debugger might modify its value), whereas *implicit locations*
4681 describe merely the actual *value* of a source variable which might not exist
4682 in registers or in memory (see ``DW_OP_stack_value``).
4684 A ``llvm.dbg.addr`` or ``llvm.dbg.declare`` intrinsic describes an indirect
4685 value (the address) of a source variable. The first operand of the intrinsic
4686 must be an address of some kind. A DIExpression attached to the intrinsic
4687 refines this address to produce a concrete location for the source variable.
4689 A ``llvm.dbg.value`` intrinsic describes the direct value of a source variable.
4690 The first operand of the intrinsic may be a direct or indirect value. A
4691 DIExpresion attached to the intrinsic refines the first operand to produce a
4692 direct value. For example, if the first operand is an indirect value, it may be
4693 necessary to insert ``DW_OP_deref`` into the DIExpresion in order to produce a
4694 valid debug intrinsic.
4698 A DIExpression is interpreted in the same way regardless of which kind of
4699 debug intrinsic it's attached to.
4701 .. code-block:: text
4703 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
4704 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus_uconst, 3)
4705 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus)
4706 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
4707 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus, DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 3, 7)
4708 !4 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 2, DW_OP_swap, DW_OP_xderef)
4709 !5 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 42, DW_OP_stack_value)
4714 ``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
4716 .. code-block:: text
4718 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
4719 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4724 ``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
4727 .. code-block:: text
4729 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
4730 entity: !1, line: 7)
4735 ``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4736 The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
4737 defining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
4738 used to expand the macro identifier.
4740 .. code-block:: text
4742 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4744 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4749 ``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4750 The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4751 appear in the included source file.
4753 .. code-block:: text
4755 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4761 In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
4762 suitable for doing type based alias analysis (TBAA). Instead, metadata is
4763 added to the IR to describe a type system of a higher level language. This
4764 can be used to implement C/C++ strict type aliasing rules, but it can also
4765 be used to implement custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
4767 This description of LLVM's TBAA system is broken into two parts:
4768 :ref:`Semantics<tbaa_node_semantics>` talks about high level issues, and
4769 :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` talks about the metadata
4770 encoding of various entities.
4772 It is always possible to trace any TBAA node to a "root" TBAA node (details
4773 in the :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` section). TBAA
4774 nodes with different roots have an unknown aliasing relationship, and LLVM
4775 conservatively infers ``MayAlias`` between them. The rules mentioned in
4776 this section only pertain to TBAA nodes living under the same root.
4778 .. _tbaa_node_semantics:
4783 The TBAA metadata system, referred to as "struct path TBAA" (not to be
4784 confused with ``tbaa.struct``), consists of the following high level
4785 concepts: *Type Descriptors*, further subdivided into scalar type
4786 descriptors and struct type descriptors; and *Access Tags*.
4788 **Type descriptors** describe the type system of the higher level language
4789 being compiled. **Scalar type descriptors** describe types that do not
4790 contain other types. Each scalar type has a parent type, which must also
4791 be a scalar type or the TBAA root. Via this parent relation, scalar types
4792 within a TBAA root form a tree. **Struct type descriptors** denote types
4793 that contain a sequence of other type descriptors, at known offsets. These
4794 contained type descriptors can either be struct type descriptors themselves
4795 or scalar type descriptors.
4797 **Access tags** are metadata nodes attached to load and store instructions.
4798 Access tags use type descriptors to describe the *location* being accessed
4799 in terms of the type system of the higher level language. Access tags are
4800 tuples consisting of a base type, an access type and an offset. The base
4801 type is a scalar type descriptor or a struct type descriptor, the access
4802 type is a scalar type descriptor, and the offset is a constant integer.
4804 The access tag ``(BaseTy, AccessTy, Offset)`` can describe one of two
4807 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type, the tag describes a memory access (load
4808 or store) of a value of type ``AccessTy`` contained in the struct type
4809 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset``.
4811 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type, ``Offset`` must be 0 and ``BaseTy`` and
4812 ``AccessTy`` must be the same; and the access tag describes a scalar
4813 access with scalar type ``AccessTy``.
4815 We first define an ``ImmediateParent`` relation on ``(BaseTy, Offset)``
4818 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, 0)`` is
4819 ``(ParentTy, 0)`` where ``ParentTy`` is the parent of the scalar type as
4820 described in the TBAA metadata. ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)`` is
4821 undefined if ``Offset`` is non-zero.
4823 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)``
4824 is ``(NewTy, NewOffset)`` where ``NewTy`` is the type contained in
4825 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset`` and ``NewOffset`` is ``Offset`` adjusted
4826 to be relative within that inner type.
4828 A memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy1, AccessTy1, Offset1)``
4829 aliases a memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy2, AccessTy2,
4830 Offset2)`` if either ``(BaseTy1, Offset1)`` is reachable from ``(Base2,
4831 Offset2)`` via the ``Parent`` relation or vice versa.
4833 As a concrete example, the type descriptor graph for the following program
4839 float f; // offset 4
4843 float f; // offset 0
4844 double d; // offset 4
4845 struct Inner inner_a; // offset 12
4848 void f(struct Outer* outer, struct Inner* inner, float* f, int* i, char* c) {
4849 outer->f = 0; // tag0: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4850 outer->inner_a.i = 0; // tag1: (OuterStructTy, IntScalarTy, 12)
4851 outer->inner_a.f = 0.0; // tag2: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 16)
4852 *f = 0.0; // tag3: (FloatScalarTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4855 is (note that in C and C++, ``char`` can be used to access any arbitrary
4858 .. code-block:: text
4861 CharScalarTy = ("char", Root, 0)
4862 FloatScalarTy = ("float", CharScalarTy, 0)
4863 DoubleScalarTy = ("double", CharScalarTy, 0)
4864 IntScalarTy = ("int", CharScalarTy, 0)
4865 InnerStructTy = {"Inner" (IntScalarTy, 0), (FloatScalarTy, 4)}
4866 OuterStructTy = {"Outer", (FloatScalarTy, 0), (DoubleScalarTy, 4),
4867 (InnerStructTy, 12)}
4870 with (e.g.) ``ImmediateParent(OuterStructTy, 12)`` = ``(InnerStructTy,
4871 0)``, ``ImmediateParent(InnerStructTy, 0)`` = ``(IntScalarTy, 0)``, and
4872 ``ImmediateParent(IntScalarTy, 0)`` = ``(CharScalarTy, 0)``.
4874 .. _tbaa_node_representation:
4879 The root node of a TBAA type hierarchy is an ``MDNode`` with 0 operands or
4880 with exactly one ``MDString`` operand.
4882 Scalar type descriptors are represented as an ``MDNode`` s with two
4883 operands. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting the name of the
4884 struct type. LLVM does not assign meaning to the value of this operand, it
4885 only cares about it being an ``MDString``. The second operand is an
4886 ``MDNode`` which points to the parent for said scalar type descriptor,
4887 which is either another scalar type descriptor or the TBAA root. Scalar
4888 type descriptors can have an optional third argument, but that must be the
4889 constant integer zero.
4891 Struct type descriptors are represented as ``MDNode`` s with an odd number
4892 of operands greater than 1. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting
4893 the name of the struct type. Like in scalar type descriptors the actual
4894 value of this name operand is irrelevant to LLVM. After the name operand,
4895 the struct type descriptors have a sequence of alternating ``MDNode`` and
4896 ``ConstantInt`` operands. With N starting from 1, the 2N - 1 th operand,
4897 an ``MDNode``, denotes a contained field, and the 2N th operand, a
4898 ``ConstantInt``, is the offset of the said contained field. The offsets
4899 must be in non-decreasing order.
4901 Access tags are represented as ``MDNode`` s with either 3 or 4 operands.
4902 The first operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node representing the
4903 base type. The second operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node
4904 representing the access type. The third operand is a ``ConstantInt`` that
4905 states the offset of the access. If a fourth field is present, it must be
4906 a ``ConstantInt`` valued at 0 or 1. If it is 1 then the access tag states
4907 that the location being accessed is "constant" (meaning
4908 ``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
4909 AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_). The TBAA root of
4910 the access type and the base type of an access tag must be the same, and
4911 that is the TBAA root of the access tag.
4913 '``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
4914 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4916 The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
4917 aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
4918 is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
4919 strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
4920 padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
4923 ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
4924 memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
4926 The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
4927 nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4928 For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4929 field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4932 .. code-block:: llvm
4934 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
4936 This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4937 with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4938 and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4940 Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
4941 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4942 does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4944 '``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
4945 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4947 ``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4948 noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4949 instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4950 ``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4951 collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
4952 Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
4955 When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
4956 of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
4957 subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
4958 instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4961 Because scopes in one domain don't affect scopes in other domains, separate
4962 domains can be used to compose multiple independent noalias sets. This is
4963 used for example during inlining. As the noalias function parameters are
4964 turned into noalias scope metadata, a new domain is used every time the
4965 function is inlined.
4967 The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
4968 entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
4969 string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
4970 self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
4971 descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
4973 The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
4974 three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
4975 is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
4976 self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
4977 reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
4978 optionally be provided as a third list entry.
4982 .. code-block:: llvm
4984 ; Two scope domains:
4988 ; Some scopes in these domains:
4994 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
4998 ; These two instructions don't alias:
4999 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
5000 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
5002 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
5003 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
5004 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
5005 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
5007 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
5008 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
5009 ; !alias.scope list):
5010 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
5011 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
5013 '``fpmath``' Metadata
5014 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5016 ``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating-point
5017 type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
5018 result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
5019 compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
5020 it. ULP is defined as follows:
5022 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
5023 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
5024 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
5025 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
5026 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
5028 The metadata node shall consist of a single positive float type number
5029 representing the maximum relative error, for example:
5031 .. code-block:: llvm
5033 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
5037 '``range``' Metadata
5038 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5040 ``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
5041 integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
5042 returned by the called function at this call site is in. If the loaded or
5043 returned value is not in the specified range, the behavior is undefined. The
5044 ranges are represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or
5045 the value returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each
5046 consecutive pair. Each pair has the following properties:
5048 - The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
5049 - The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
5050 - Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
5051 - The range is allowed to wrap.
5052 - The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
5055 In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
5056 they must be non-contiguous.
5060 .. code-block:: llvm
5062 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
5063 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
5064 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
5065 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
5066 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
5068 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
5069 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
5070 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
5071 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
5073 '``absolute_symbol``' Metadata
5074 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5076 ``absolute_symbol`` metadata may be attached to a global variable
5077 declaration. It marks the declaration as a reference to an absolute symbol,
5078 which causes the backend to use absolute relocations for the symbol even
5079 in position independent code, and expresses the possible ranges that the
5080 global variable's *address* (not its value) is in, in the same format as
5081 ``range`` metadata, with the extension that the pair ``all-ones,all-ones``
5082 may be used to represent the full set.
5084 Example (assuming 64-bit pointers):
5086 .. code-block:: llvm
5088 @a = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !0 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,256)
5089 @b = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !1 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,2^64)
5092 !0 = !{ i64 0, i64 256 }
5093 !1 = !{ i64 -1, i64 -1 }
5095 '``callees``' Metadata
5096 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5098 ``callees`` metadata may be attached to indirect call sites. If ``callees``
5099 metadata is attached to a call site, and any callee is not among the set of
5100 functions provided by the metadata, the behavior is undefined. The intent of
5101 this metadata is to facilitate optimizations such as indirect-call promotion.
5102 For example, in the code below, the call instruction may only target the
5103 ``add`` or ``sub`` functions:
5105 .. code-block:: llvm
5107 %result = call i64 %binop(i64 %x, i64 %y), !callees !0
5110 !0 = !{i64 (i64, i64)* @add, i64 (i64, i64)* @sub}
5112 '``callback``' Metadata
5113 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5115 ``callback`` metadata may be attached to a function declaration, or definition.
5116 (Call sites are excluded only due to the lack of a use case.) For ease of
5117 exposition, we'll refer to the function annotated w/ metadata as a broker
5118 function. The metadata describes how the arguments of a call to the broker are
5119 in turn passed to the callback function specified by the metadata. Thus, the
5120 ``callback`` metadata provides a partial description of a call site inside the
5121 broker function with regards to the arguments of a call to the broker. The only
5122 semantic restriction on the broker function itself is that it is not allowed to
5123 inspect or modify arguments referenced in the ``callback`` metadata as
5124 pass-through to the callback function.
5126 The broker is not required to actually invoke the callback function at runtime.
5127 However, the assumptions about not inspecting or modifying arguments that would
5128 be passed to the specified callback function still hold, even if the callback
5129 function is not dynamically invoked. The broker is allowed to invoke the
5130 callback function more than once per invocation of the broker. The broker is
5131 also allowed to invoke (directly or indirectly) the function passed as a
5132 callback through another use. Finally, the broker is also allowed to relay the
5133 callback callee invocation to a different thread.
5135 The metadata is structured as follows: At the outer level, ``callback``
5136 metadata is a list of ``callback`` encodings. Each encoding starts with a
5137 constant ``i64`` which describes the argument position of the callback function
5138 in the call to the broker. The following elements, except the last, describe
5139 what arguments are passed to the callback function. Each element is again an
5140 ``i64`` constant identifying the argument of the broker that is passed through,
5141 or ``i64 -1`` to indicate an unknown or inspected argument. The order in which
5142 they are listed has to be the same in which they are passed to the callback
5143 callee. The last element of the encoding is a boolean which specifies how
5144 variadic arguments of the broker are handled. If it is true, all variadic
5145 arguments of the broker are passed through to the callback function *after* the
5146 arguments encoded explicitly before.
5148 In the code below, the ``pthread_create`` function is marked as a broker
5149 through the ``!callback !1`` metadata. In the example, there is only one
5150 callback encoding, namely ``!2``, associated with the broker. This encoding
5151 identifies the callback function as the second argument of the broker (``i64
5152 2``) and the sole argument of the callback function as the third one of the
5153 broker function (``i64 3``).
5155 .. FIXME why does the llvm-sphinx-docs builder give a highlighting
5156 error if the below is set to highlight as 'llvm', despite that we
5157 have misc.highlighting_failure set?
5159 .. code-block:: text
5161 declare !callback !1 dso_local i32 @pthread_create(i64*, %union.pthread_attr_t*, i8* (i8*)*, i8*)
5164 !2 = !{i64 2, i64 3, i1 false}
5167 Another example is shown below. The callback callee is the second argument of
5168 the ``__kmpc_fork_call`` function (``i64 2``). The callee is given two unknown
5169 values (each identified by a ``i64 -1``) and afterwards all
5170 variadic arguments that are passed to the ``__kmpc_fork_call`` call (due to the
5173 .. FIXME why does the llvm-sphinx-docs builder give a highlighting
5174 error if the below is set to highlight as 'llvm', despite that we
5175 have misc.highlighting_failure set?
5177 .. code-block:: text
5179 declare !callback !0 dso_local void @__kmpc_fork_call(%struct.ident_t*, i32, void (i32*, i32*, ...)*, ...)
5182 !1 = !{i64 2, i64 -1, i64 -1, i1 true}
5186 '``unpredictable``' Metadata
5187 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5189 ``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
5190 instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
5191 flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
5192 optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
5193 is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
5194 or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
5201 It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
5202 loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
5203 in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
5204 guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
5205 specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
5207 The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
5208 itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
5209 during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
5210 to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
5211 The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
5214 .. code-block:: llvm
5219 The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
5220 per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
5221 as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
5222 suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
5224 .. code-block:: llvm
5226 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
5229 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5231 '``llvm.loop.disable_nonforced``'
5232 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5234 This metadata disables all optional loop transformations unless
5235 explicitly instructed using other transformation metdata such as
5236 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. That is, no heuristic will try to determine
5237 whether a transformation is profitable. The purpose is to avoid that the
5238 loop is transformed to a different loop before an explicitly requested
5239 (forced) transformation is applied. For instance, loop fusion can make
5240 other transformations impossible. Mandatory loop canonicalizations such
5241 as loop rotation are still applied.
5243 It is recommended to use this metadata in addition to any llvm.loop.*
5244 transformation directive. Also, any loop should have at most one
5245 directive applied to it (and a sequence of transformations built using
5246 followup-attributes). Otherwise, which transformation will be applied
5247 depends on implementation details such as the pass pipeline order.
5249 See :ref:`transformation-metadata` for details.
5251 '``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
5252 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5254 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
5255 used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
5256 vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
5257 conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
5258 ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
5259 optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
5260 it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata
5261 which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
5262 in determining the safety of these transformations.
5264 '``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
5265 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5267 This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
5268 The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
5269 second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
5272 .. code-block:: llvm
5274 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
5276 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
5277 multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
5278 then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
5280 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
5281 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5283 This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
5284 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
5285 is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
5286 0 disables vectorization:
5288 .. code-block:: llvm
5290 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
5291 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
5293 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
5294 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5296 This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
5297 operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
5298 operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
5300 .. code-block:: llvm
5302 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
5304 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
5305 vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
5306 0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
5307 determined automatically.
5309 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_vectorized``' Metadata
5310 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5312 This metadata defines which loop attributes the vectorized loop will
5313 have. See :ref:`transformation-metadata` for details.
5315 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_epilogue``' Metadata
5316 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5318 This metadata defines which loop attributes the epilogue will have. The
5319 epilogue is not vectorized and is executed when either the vectorized
5320 loop is not known to preserve semantics (because e.g., it processes two
5321 arrays that are found to alias by a runtime check) or for the last
5322 iterations that do not fill a complete set of vector lanes. See
5323 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5325 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.followup_all``' Metadata
5326 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5328 Attributes in the metadata will be added to both the vectorized and
5330 See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5332 '``llvm.loop.unroll``'
5333 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5335 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
5336 optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
5337 metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5338 identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
5339 optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
5340 optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
5342 '``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
5343 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5345 This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
5346 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
5347 operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
5350 .. code-block:: llvm
5352 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5354 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5355 will be partially unrolled.
5357 '``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
5358 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5360 This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
5361 which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
5363 .. code-block:: llvm
5365 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
5367 '``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
5368 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5370 This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
5371 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
5373 .. code-block:: llvm
5375 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
5377 '``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
5378 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5380 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
5381 is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
5382 at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
5383 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
5385 .. code-block:: llvm
5387 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
5389 '``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
5390 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5392 This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
5393 metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
5396 .. code-block:: llvm
5398 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
5400 '``llvm.loop.unroll.followup``' Metadata
5401 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5403 This metadata defines which loop attributes the unrolled loop will have.
5404 See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5406 '``llvm.loop.unroll.followup_remainder``' Metadata
5407 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5409 This metadata defines which loop attributes the remainder loop after
5410 partial/runtime unrolling will have. See
5411 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5413 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam``'
5414 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5416 This metadata is treated very similarly to the ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata
5417 above, but affect the unroll and jam pass. In addition any loop with
5418 ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata but no ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam`` metadata will
5419 disable unroll and jam (so ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata will be left to the
5420 unroller, plus ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable`` metadata will disable unroll and jam
5423 The metadata for unroll and jam otherwise is the same as for ``unroll``.
5424 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``, ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable`` and
5425 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` do the same as for unroll.
5426 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.full`` is not supported. Again these are only hints
5427 and the normal safety checks will still be performed.
5429 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count``' Metadata
5430 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5432 This metadata suggests an unroll and jam factor to use, similarly to
5433 ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``. The first operand is the string
5434 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` and the second operand is a positive integer
5435 specifying the unroll factor. For example:
5437 .. code-block:: llvm
5439 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count", i32 4}
5441 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5442 will be partially unroll and jammed.
5444 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``' Metadata
5445 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5447 This metadata disables loop unroll and jamming. The metadata has a single
5448 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``. For example:
5450 .. code-block:: llvm
5452 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable"}
5454 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``' Metadata
5455 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5457 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unroll and jammed if the
5458 trip count is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is
5459 not known at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the
5460 string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``. For example:
5462 .. code-block:: llvm
5464 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable"}
5466 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_outer``' Metadata
5467 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5469 This metadata defines which loop attributes the outer unrolled loop will
5470 have. See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for
5473 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_inner``' Metadata
5474 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5476 This metadata defines which loop attributes the inner jammed loop will
5477 have. See :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for
5480 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_remainder_outer``' Metadata
5481 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5483 This metadata defines which attributes the epilogue of the outer loop
5484 will have. This loop is usually unrolled, meaning there is no such
5485 loop. This attribute will be ignored in this case. See
5486 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5488 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_remainder_inner``' Metadata
5489 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5491 This metadata defines which attributes the inner loop of the epilogue
5492 will have. The outer epilogue will usually be unrolled, meaning there
5493 can be multiple inner remainder loops. See
5494 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5496 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.followup_all``' Metadata
5497 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5499 Attributes specified in the metadata is added to all
5500 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.*`` loops. See
5501 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5503 '``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``' Metadata
5504 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5506 This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
5507 of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
5508 which is the string ``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``. For example:
5510 .. code-block:: llvm
5512 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
5514 '``llvm.loop.distribute.enable``' Metadata
5515 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5517 Loop distribution allows splitting a loop into multiple loops. Currently,
5518 this is only performed if the entire loop cannot be vectorized due to unsafe
5519 memory dependencies. The transformation will attempt to isolate the unsafe
5520 dependencies into their own loop.
5522 This metadata can be used to selectively enable or disable distribution of the
5523 loop. The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.distribute.enable`` and the
5524 second operand is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 distribution is
5525 enabled. A value of 0 disables distribution:
5527 .. code-block:: llvm
5529 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 0}
5530 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 1}
5532 This metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5533 identification metadata.
5535 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_coincident``' Metadata
5536 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5538 This metadata defines which attributes extracted loops with no cyclic
5539 dependencies will have (i.e. can be vectorized). See
5540 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5542 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_sequential``' Metadata
5543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5545 This metadata defines which attributes the isolated loops with unsafe
5546 memory dependencies will have. See
5547 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5549 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_fallback``' Metadata
5550 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5552 If loop versioning is necessary, this metadata defined the attributes
5553 the non-distributed fallback version will have. See
5554 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5556 '``llvm.loop.distribute.followup_all``' Metadata
5557 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5559 Thes attributes in this metdata is added to all followup loops of the
5560 loop distribution pass. See
5561 :ref:`Transformation Metadata <transformation-metadata>` for details.
5563 '``llvm.access.group``' Metadata
5564 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5566 ``llvm.access.group`` metadata can be attached to any instruction that
5567 potentially accesses memory. It can point to a single distinct metadata
5568 node, which we call access group. This node represents all memory access
5569 instructions referring to it via ``llvm.access.group``. When an
5570 instruction belongs to multiple access groups, it can also point to a
5571 list of accesses groups, illustrated by the following example.
5573 .. code-block:: llvm
5575 %val = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.access.group !0
5581 It is illegal for the list node to be empty since it might be confused
5582 with an access group.
5584 The access group metadata node must be 'distinct' to avoid collapsing
5585 multiple access groups by content. A access group metadata node must
5586 always be empty which can be used to distinguish an access group
5587 metadata node from a list of access groups. Being empty avoids the
5588 situation that the content must be updated which, because metadata is
5589 immutable by design, would required finding and updating all references
5590 to the access group node.
5592 The access group can be used to refer to a memory access instruction
5593 without pointing to it directly (which is not possible in global
5594 metadata). Currently, the only metadata making use of it is
5595 ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``.
5597 '``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``' Metadata
5598 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5600 The ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata refers to one or more
5601 access group metadata nodes (see ``llvm.access.group``). It denotes that
5602 no loop-carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions
5603 in the loop with this metadata.
5605 Let ``m1`` and ``m2`` be two instructions that both have the
5606 ``llvm.access.group`` metadata to the access group ``g1``, respectively
5607 ``g2`` (which might be identical). If a loop contains both access groups
5608 in its ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata, then the compiler can
5609 assume that there is no dependency between ``m1`` and ``m2`` carried by
5610 this loop. Instructions that belong to multiple access groups are
5611 considered having this property if at least one of the access groups
5612 matches the ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` list.
5614 If all memory-accessing instructions in a loop have
5615 ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
5616 loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a
5619 Note that if not all memory access instructions belong to an access
5620 group referred to by ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``, then the loop must
5621 not be considered trivially parallel. Additional
5622 memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
5623 safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
5624 sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
5625 insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
5627 Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
5628 both ``llvm.access.group`` and ``llvm.loop.parallel_accesses``
5631 .. code-block:: llvm
5635 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.access.group !1
5637 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.access.group !1
5639 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
5643 !0 = distinct !{!0, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !1}}
5646 It is also possible to have nested parallel loops:
5648 .. code-block:: llvm
5652 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.access.group !4
5654 br label %inner.for.body
5658 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.access.group !3
5660 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.access.group !3
5662 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
5666 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.access.group !4
5668 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
5670 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
5672 !1 = distinct !{!1, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !3}} ; metadata for the inner loop
5673 !2 = distinct !{!2, !{!"llvm.loop.parallel_accesses", !3, !4}} ; metadata for the outer loop
5674 !3 = distinct !{} ; access group for instructions in the inner loop (which are implicitly contained in outer loop as well)
5675 !4 = distinct !{} ; access group for instructions in the outer, but not the inner loop
5677 '``irr_loop``' Metadata
5678 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5680 ``irr_loop`` metadata may be attached to the terminator instruction of a basic
5681 block that's an irreducible loop header (note that an irreducible loop has more
5682 than once header basic blocks.) If ``irr_loop`` metadata is attached to the
5683 terminator instruction of a basic block that is not really an irreducible loop
5684 header, the behavior is undefined. The intent of this metadata is to improve the
5685 accuracy of the block frequency propagation. For example, in the code below, the
5686 block ``header0`` may have a loop header weight (relative to the other headers of
5687 the irreducible loop) of 100:
5689 .. code-block:: llvm
5693 br i1 %cmp, label %t1, label %t2, !irr_loop !0
5696 !0 = !{"loop_header_weight", i64 100}
5698 Irreducible loop header weights are typically based on profile data.
5700 '``invariant.group``' Metadata
5701 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5703 The experimental ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to
5704 ``load``/``store`` instructions referencing a single metadata with no entries.
5705 The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
5706 the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
5707 can be assumed to load or store the same
5708 value (but see the ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` intrinsic which affects
5709 when two pointers are considered the same). Pointers returned by bitcast or
5710 getelementptr with only zero indices are considered the same.
5714 .. code-block:: llvm
5716 @unknownPtr = external global i8
5719 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
5720 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5722 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
5723 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5725 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
5726 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
5728 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
5729 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
5731 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5732 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8* %ptr)
5733 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through launder.invariant.group to get value of %ptr
5736 declare void @foo(i8*)
5737 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
5738 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8*)
5742 The invariant.group metadata must be dropped when replacing one pointer by
5743 another based on aliasing information. This is because invariant.group is tied
5744 to the SSA value of the pointer operand.
5746 .. code-block:: llvm
5748 %v = load i8, i8* %x, !invariant.group !0
5749 ; if %x mustalias %y then we can replace the above instruction with
5750 %v = load i8, i8* %y
5752 Note that this is an experimental feature, which means that its semantics might
5753 change in the future.
5758 See :doc:`TypeMetadata`.
5760 '``associated``' Metadata
5761 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5763 The ``associated`` metadata may be attached to a global object
5764 declaration with a single argument that references another global object.
5766 This metadata prevents discarding of the global object in linker GC
5767 unless the referenced object is also discarded. The linker support for
5768 this feature is spotty. For best compatibility, globals carrying this
5771 - Be in a comdat with the referenced global.
5772 - Be in @llvm.compiler.used.
5773 - Have an explicit section with a name which is a valid C identifier.
5775 It does not have any effect on non-ELF targets.
5779 .. code-block:: text
5782 @a = global i32 1, comdat $a
5783 @b = internal global i32 2, comdat $a, section "abc", !associated !0
5790 The ``prof`` metadata is used to record profile data in the IR.
5791 The first operand of the metadata node indicates the profile metadata
5792 type. There are currently 3 types:
5793 :ref:`branch_weights<prof_node_branch_weights>`,
5794 :ref:`function_entry_count<prof_node_function_entry_count>`, and
5795 :ref:`VP<prof_node_VP>`.
5797 .. _prof_node_branch_weights:
5802 Branch weight metadata attached to a branch, select, switch or call instruction
5803 represents the likeliness of the associated branch being taken.
5804 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5806 .. _prof_node_function_entry_count:
5808 function_entry_count
5809 """"""""""""""""""""
5811 Function entry count metadata can be attached to function definitions
5812 to record the number of times the function is called. Used with BFI
5813 information, it is also used to derive the basic block profile count.
5814 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5821 VP (value profile) metadata can be attached to instructions that have
5822 value profile information. Currently this is indirect calls (where it
5823 records the hottest callees) and calls to memory intrinsics such as memcpy,
5824 memmove, and memset (where it records the hottest byte lengths).
5826 Each VP metadata node contains "VP" string, then a uint32_t value for the value
5827 profiling kind, a uint64_t value for the total number of times the instruction
5828 is executed, followed by uint64_t value and execution count pairs.
5829 The value profiling kind is 0 for indirect call targets and 1 for memory
5830 operations. For indirect call targets, each profile value is a hash
5831 of the callee function name, and for memory operations each value is the
5834 Note that the value counts do not need to add up to the total count
5835 listed in the third operand (in practice only the top hottest values
5836 are tracked and reported).
5838 Indirect call example:
5840 .. code-block:: llvm
5842 call void %f(), !prof !1
5843 !1 = !{!"VP", i32 0, i64 1600, i64 7651369219802541373, i64 1030, i64 -4377547752858689819, i64 410}
5845 Note that the VP type is 0 (the second operand), which indicates this is
5846 an indirect call value profile data. The third operand indicates that the
5847 indirect call executed 1600 times. The 4th and 6th operands give the
5848 hashes of the 2 hottest target functions' names (this is the same hash used
5849 to represent function names in the profile database), and the 5th and 7th
5850 operands give the execution count that each of the respective prior target
5851 functions was called.
5853 Module Flags Metadata
5854 =====================
5856 Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
5857 subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
5858 The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
5859 this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
5860 dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
5863 The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
5864 Each triplet has the following form:
5866 - The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
5867 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
5868 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
5870 - The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
5871 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
5872 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
5873 - The third element is the value of the flag.
5875 When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
5876 ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
5877 each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
5878 modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
5879 be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
5880 is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
5882 The following behaviors are supported:
5893 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
5894 is that of the operands.
5898 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
5899 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
5903 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
5904 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
5905 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
5906 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
5907 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
5908 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
5909 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
5913 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
5914 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
5915 differ, an error will be emitted.
5919 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
5923 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
5924 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
5925 during the append operation.
5929 Takes the max of the two values, which are required to be integers.
5931 It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
5932 except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
5933 value) or **Override**.
5935 An example of module flags:
5937 .. code-block:: llvm
5939 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
5940 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
5941 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
5942 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
5947 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
5949 - Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
5950 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
5951 values are not equal.
5953 - Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
5954 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
5957 - Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
5958 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
5959 warning if their values are not equal.
5961 - Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
5967 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
5968 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
5971 Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
5972 ----------------------------------------------------
5974 On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
5975 collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
5976 consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
5977 garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
5978 modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
5979 be merged rather than appended together.
5981 The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
5982 following key-value pairs:
5991 * - ``Objective-C Version``
5992 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
5994 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
5995 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
5998 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
5999 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
6000 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
6001 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
6002 Objective-C ABI version 2.
6004 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
6005 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
6006 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
6007 collection supported.
6009 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
6010 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
6011 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
6012 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
6014 Some important flag interactions:
6016 - If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
6017 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
6018 2, then the resulting module has the
6019 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
6020 - A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
6021 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
6023 C type width Module Flags Metadata
6024 ----------------------------------
6026 The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
6027 options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
6028 linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
6029 of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
6032 To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
6033 flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
6043 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
6044 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
6047 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
6048 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
6049 represent all of its values.
6051 For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
6052 compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
6053 enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
6055 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
6056 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
6057 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
6059 Automatic Linker Flags Named Metadata
6060 =====================================
6062 Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
6063 files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
6064 allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
6065 these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
6067 These flags are encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
6068 ``!llvm.linker.options``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
6069 which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
6070 list of metadata strings defining linker options.
6072 For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
6073 linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
6077 !1 = !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
6078 !llvm.linker.options = !{ !0, !1 }
6080 The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
6081 list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
6082 strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
6083 preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
6084 assembly writer or object file emitter.
6086 Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
6087 linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
6088 object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
6095 Compiling with `ThinLTO <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/ThinLTO.html>`_
6096 causes the building of a compact summary of the module that is emitted into
6097 the bitcode. The summary is emitted into the LLVM assembly and identified
6098 in syntax by a caret ('``^``').
6100 The summary is parsed into a bitcode output, along with the Module
6101 IR, via the "``llvm-as``" tool. Tools that parse the Module IR for the purposes
6102 of optimization (e.g. "``clang -x ir``" and "``opt``"), will ignore the
6103 summary entries (just as they currently ignore summary entries in a bitcode
6106 Eventually, the summary will be parsed into a ModuleSummaryIndex object under
6107 the same conditions where summary index is currently built from bitcode.
6108 Specifically, tools that test the Thin Link portion of a ThinLTO compile
6109 (i.e. llvm-lto and llvm-lto2), or when parsing a combined index
6110 for a distributed ThinLTO backend via clang's "``-fthinlto-index=<>``" flag
6111 (this part is not yet implemented, use llvm-as to create a bitcode object
6112 before feeding into thin link tools for now).
6114 There are currently 3 types of summary entries in the LLVM assembly:
6115 :ref:`module paths<module_path_summary>`,
6116 :ref:`global values<gv_summary>`, and
6117 :ref:`type identifiers<typeid_summary>`.
6119 .. _module_path_summary:
6121 Module Path Summary Entry
6122 -------------------------
6124 Each module path summary entry lists a module containing global values included
6125 in the summary. For a single IR module there will be one such entry, but
6126 in a combined summary index produced during the thin link, there will be
6127 one module path entry per linked module with summary.
6131 .. code-block:: text
6133 ^0 = module: (path: "/path/to/file.o", hash: (2468601609, 1329373163, 1565878005, 638838075, 3148790418))
6135 The ``path`` field is a string path to the bitcode file, and the ``hash``
6136 field is the 160-bit SHA-1 hash of the IR bitcode contents, used for
6137 incremental builds and caching.
6141 Global Value Summary Entry
6142 --------------------------
6144 Each global value summary entry corresponds to a global value defined or
6145 referenced by a summarized module.
6149 .. code-block:: text
6151 ^4 = gv: (name: "f"[, summaries: (Summary)[, (Summary)]*]?) ; guid = 14740650423002898831
6153 For declarations, there will not be a summary list. For definitions, a
6154 global value will contain a list of summaries, one per module containing
6155 a definition. There can be multiple entries in a combined summary index
6156 for symbols with weak linkage.
6158 Each ``Summary`` format will depend on whether the global value is a
6159 :ref:`function<function_summary>`, :ref:`variable<variable_summary>`, or
6160 :ref:`alias<alias_summary>`.
6162 .. _function_summary:
6167 If the global value is a function, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6169 .. code-block:: text
6171 function: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), insts: 2[, FuncFlags]?[, Calls]?[, TypeIdInfo]?[, Refs]?
6173 The ``module`` field includes the summary entry id for the module containing
6174 this definition, and the ``flags`` field contains information such as
6175 the linkage type, a flag indicating whether it is legal to import the
6176 definition, whether it is globally live and whether the linker resolved it
6177 to a local definition (the latter two are populated during the thin link).
6178 The ``insts`` field contains the number of IR instructions in the function.
6179 Finally, there are several optional fields: :ref:`FuncFlags<funcflags_summary>`,
6180 :ref:`Calls<calls_summary>`, :ref:`TypeIdInfo<typeidinfo_summary>`,
6181 :ref:`Refs<refs_summary>`.
6183 .. _variable_summary:
6185 Global Variable Summary
6186 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6188 If the global value is a variable, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6190 .. code-block:: text
6192 variable: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0)[, Refs]?
6194 The variable entry contains a subset of the fields in a
6195 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`, see the descriptions there.
6202 If the global value is an alias, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
6204 .. code-block:: text
6206 alias: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), aliasee: ^2)
6208 The ``module`` and ``flags`` fields are as described for a
6209 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`. The ``aliasee`` field
6210 contains a reference to the global value summary entry of the aliasee.
6212 .. _funcflags_summary:
6217 The optional ``FuncFlags`` field looks like:
6219 .. code-block:: text
6221 funcFlags: (readNone: 0, readOnly: 0, noRecurse: 0, returnDoesNotAlias: 0)
6223 If unspecified, flags are assumed to hold the conservative ``false`` value of
6231 The optional ``Calls`` field looks like:
6233 .. code-block:: text
6235 calls: ((Callee)[, (Callee)]*)
6237 where each ``Callee`` looks like:
6239 .. code-block:: text
6241 callee: ^1[, hotness: None]?[, relbf: 0]?
6243 The ``callee`` refers to the summary entry id of the callee. At most one
6244 of ``hotness`` (which can take the values ``Unknown``, ``Cold``, ``None``,
6245 ``Hot``, and ``Critical``), and ``relbf`` (which holds the integer
6246 branch frequency relative to the entry frequency, scaled down by 2^8)
6247 may be specified. The defaults are ``Unknown`` and ``0``, respectively.
6254 The optional ``Refs`` field looks like:
6256 .. code-block:: text
6258 refs: ((Ref)[, (Ref)]*)
6260 where each ``Ref`` contains a reference to the summary id of the referenced
6261 value (e.g. ``^1``).
6263 .. _typeidinfo_summary:
6268 The optional ``TypeIdInfo`` field, used for
6269 `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6272 .. code-block:: text
6274 typeIdInfo: [(TypeTests)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadVCalls)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls)]?
6276 These optional fields have the following forms:
6281 .. code-block:: text
6283 typeTests: (TypeIdRef[, TypeIdRef]*)
6285 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6286 by summary id or ``GUID``.
6288 TypeTestAssumeVCalls
6289 """"""""""""""""""""
6291 .. code-block:: text
6293 typeTestAssumeVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6295 Where each VFuncId has the format:
6297 .. code-block:: text
6299 vFuncId: (TypeIdRef, offset: 16)
6301 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6302 by summary id or ``GUID`` preceeded by a ``guid:`` tag.
6304 TypeCheckedLoadVCalls
6305 """""""""""""""""""""
6307 .. code-block:: text
6309 typeCheckedLoadVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6311 Where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``.
6313 TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls
6314 """""""""""""""""""""""""
6316 .. code-block:: text
6318 typeTestAssumeConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6320 Where each ConstVCall has the format:
6322 .. code-block:: text
6324 (VFuncId, args: (Arg[, Arg]*))
6326 and where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``,
6327 and each Arg is an integer argument number.
6329 TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls
6330 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
6332 .. code-block:: text
6334 typeCheckedLoadConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6336 Where each ConstVCall has the format described for
6337 ``TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls``.
6341 Type ID Summary Entry
6342 ---------------------
6344 Each type id summary entry corresponds to a type identifier resolution
6345 which is generated during the LTO link portion of the compile when building
6346 with `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6347 so these are only present in a combined summary index.
6351 .. code-block:: text
6353 ^4 = typeid: (name: "_ZTS1A", summary: (typeTestRes: (kind: allOnes, sizeM1BitWidth: 7[, alignLog2: 0]?[, sizeM1: 0]?[, bitMask: 0]?[, inlineBits: 0]?)[, WpdResolutions]?)) ; guid = 7004155349499253778
6355 The ``typeTestRes`` gives the type test resolution ``kind`` (which may
6356 be ``unsat``, ``byteArray``, ``inline``, ``single``, or ``allOnes``), and
6357 the ``size-1`` bit width. It is followed by optional flags, which default to 0,
6358 and an optional WpdResolutions (whole program devirtualization resolution)
6359 field that looks like:
6361 .. code-block:: text
6363 wpdResolutions: ((offset: 0, WpdRes)[, (offset: 1, WpdRes)]*
6365 where each entry is a mapping from the given byte offset to the whole-program
6366 devirtualization resolution WpdRes, that has one of the following formats:
6368 .. code-block:: text
6370 wpdRes: (kind: branchFunnel)
6371 wpdRes: (kind: singleImpl, singleImplName: "_ZN1A1nEi")
6372 wpdRes: (kind: indir)
6374 Additionally, each wpdRes has an optional ``resByArg`` field, which
6375 describes the resolutions for calls with all constant integer arguments:
6377 .. code-block:: text
6379 resByArg: (ResByArg[, ResByArg]*)
6383 .. code-block:: text
6385 args: (Arg[, Arg]*), byArg: (kind: UniformRetVal[, info: 0][, byte: 0][, bit: 0])
6387 Where the ``kind`` can be ``Indir``, ``UniformRetVal``, ``UniqueRetVal``
6388 or ``VirtualConstProp``. The ``info`` field is only used if the kind
6389 is ``UniformRetVal`` (indicates the uniform return value), or
6390 ``UniqueRetVal`` (holds the return value associated with the unique vtable
6391 (0 or 1)). The ``byte`` and ``bit`` fields are only used if the target does
6392 not support the use of absolute symbols to store constants.
6394 .. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
6396 Intrinsic Global Variables
6397 ==========================
6399 LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
6400 affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
6401 All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
6402 "``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
6403 "``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
6407 The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
6408 -----------------------------------
6410 The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
6411 :ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
6412 pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
6413 have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
6416 .. code-block:: llvm
6421 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
6423 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
6424 ], section "llvm.metadata"
6426 If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
6427 and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
6428 symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
6429 a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
6430 ``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
6431 references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
6432 corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
6434 On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
6435 assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
6436 molesting the symbol.
6438 .. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
6440 The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
6441 --------------------------------------------
6443 The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
6444 directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
6445 symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
6446 optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
6449 This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
6450 and should not be exposed to source languages.
6452 .. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
6454 The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
6455 -------------------------------------------
6457 .. code-block:: llvm
6459 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6460 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
6462 The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
6463 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
6464 The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
6465 of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
6466 functions with the same priority is not defined.
6468 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
6469 or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
6470 data from the current module is not discarded.
6472 .. _llvmglobaldtors:
6474 The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
6475 -------------------------------------------
6477 .. code-block:: llvm
6479 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6480 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
6482 The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
6483 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
6484 The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
6485 order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
6486 order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
6488 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
6489 or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
6490 data from the current module is not discarded.
6492 Instruction Reference
6493 =====================
6495 The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
6496 of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
6497 instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
6498 instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
6499 :ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
6503 Terminator Instructions
6504 -----------------------
6506 As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
6507 program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
6508 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
6509 terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
6510 control flow, not values (the one exception being the
6511 ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
6513 The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
6514 ':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
6515 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
6516 ':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
6517 ':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
6518 ':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
6519 and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
6523 '``ret``' Instruction
6524 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6531 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
6532 ret void ; Return from void function
6537 The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
6538 a value) from a function back to the caller.
6540 There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
6541 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
6547 The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
6548 return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
6549 class <t_firstclass>`' type.
6551 A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it has a non-void
6552 return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
6553 a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
6554 void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
6560 When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
6561 the calling function's context. If the caller is a
6562 ":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6563 instruction after the call. If the caller was an
6564 ":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6565 beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
6566 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
6572 .. code-block:: llvm
6574 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
6575 ret void ; Return from a void function
6576 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
6580 '``br``' Instruction
6581 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6588 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
6589 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
6594 The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
6595 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
6596 this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
6597 unconditional branch.
6602 The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
6603 '``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
6604 '``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
6609 Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
6610 argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
6611 '``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
6612 to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
6617 .. code-block:: llvm
6620 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
6621 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
6629 '``switch``' Instruction
6630 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6637 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
6642 The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
6643 several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
6644 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
6650 The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
6651 comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
6652 array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
6653 is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
6658 The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
6659 When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
6660 for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
6661 to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
6662 to the default destination.
6667 Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
6668 ``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
6669 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
6670 chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
6675 .. code-block:: llvm
6677 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
6678 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
6679 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
6681 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
6682 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
6684 ; Implement a jump table:
6685 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
6687 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
6691 '``indirectbr``' Instruction
6692 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6699 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
6704 The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
6705 label within the current function, whose address is specified by
6706 "``address``". Address must be derived from a
6707 :ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
6712 The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
6713 rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
6714 that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
6715 times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
6717 This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
6718 accurate understanding of the CFG.
6723 Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
6724 possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
6725 this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
6726 labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
6731 This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
6736 .. code-block:: llvm
6738 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
6742 '``invoke``' Instruction
6743 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6750 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)] [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
6751 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
6756 The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
6757 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
6758 '``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
6759 returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
6760 "normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
6761 ":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
6762 mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
6763 nearest "exception" label.
6765 The '``exception``' label is a `landing
6766 pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
6767 '``exception``' label is required to have the
6768 ":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
6769 information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
6770 as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
6771 "``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
6772 instruction, so that the important information contained within the
6773 "``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
6778 This instruction requires several arguments:
6780 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
6781 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
6782 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
6783 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
6784 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
6786 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
6787 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
6788 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
6789 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
6790 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
6792 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being invoked. The
6793 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
6794 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
6795 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
6796 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
6797 indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
6799 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
6800 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
6801 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
6802 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
6803 extra arguments can be specified.
6804 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
6805 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
6806 #. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
6807 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
6809 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
6810 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
6815 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
6816 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
6817 establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
6818 library to unwind the stack.
6820 This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
6821 proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
6822 thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
6823 '``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
6825 For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
6826 by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
6827 current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
6828 return value is available.
6833 .. code-block:: llvm
6835 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
6836 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6837 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
6838 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6842 '``resume``' Instruction
6843 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6850 resume <type> <value>
6855 The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
6861 The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
6862 same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
6868 The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
6869 (in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
6870 :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
6875 .. code-block:: llvm
6877 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
6881 '``catchswitch``' Instruction
6882 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6889 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
6890 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
6895 The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
6896 <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
6897 that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
6902 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
6903 ``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
6904 this operand may be the token ``none``.
6906 The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
6907 either a ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination
6908 must be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in
6909 the `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
6911 The ``handlers`` are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
6912 :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
6917 Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
6918 ``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
6921 The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
6922 it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
6923 block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
6928 .. code-block:: text
6931 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
6933 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
6937 '``catchret``' Instruction
6938 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6945 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
6950 The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
6957 The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
6958 exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
6959 The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
6965 The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
6966 unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
6967 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
6968 code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
6971 The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a ``catchpad`` instruction.
6972 If the specified ``catchpad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
6973 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
6974 the ``catchret``'s behavior is undefined.
6979 .. code-block:: text
6981 catchret from %catch label %continue
6985 '``cleanupret``' Instruction
6986 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6993 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
6994 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
6999 The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
7000 an optional successor.
7006 The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
7007 which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
7008 If the specified ``cleanuppad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
7009 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
7010 the ``cleanupret``'s behavior is undefined.
7012 The '``cleanupret``' instruction also has an optional successor, ``continue``,
7013 which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
7014 ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination must
7015 be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in the
7016 `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
7021 The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
7022 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
7023 :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
7024 It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
7029 .. code-block:: text
7031 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
7032 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
7036 '``unreachable``' Instruction
7037 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7049 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
7050 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
7051 the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
7052 after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
7057 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
7064 Unary operators require a single operand, execute an operation on
7065 it, and produce a single value. The operand might represent multiple
7066 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
7067 result value has the same type as its operand.
7071 '``fneg``' Instruction
7072 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7079 <result> = fneg [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1> ; yields ty:result
7084 The '``fneg``' instruction returns the negation of its operand.
7089 The argument to the '``fneg``' instruction must be a
7090 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7091 floating-point values.
7096 The value produced is a copy of the operand with its sign bit flipped.
7097 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7098 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7099 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7104 .. code-block:: text
7106 <result> = fneg float %val ; yields float:result = -%var
7113 Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
7114 They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
7115 them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
7116 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
7117 result value has the same type as its operands.
7119 There are several different binary operators:
7123 '``add``' Instruction
7124 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7131 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7132 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7133 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7134 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7139 The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
7144 The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
7145 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7146 arguments must have identical types.
7151 The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
7153 If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
7154 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
7157 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
7158 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
7160 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7161 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7162 result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7163 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7168 .. code-block:: text
7170 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
7174 '``fadd``' Instruction
7175 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7182 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7187 The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
7192 The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be
7193 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7194 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7199 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two operands.
7200 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7201 environment <floatenv>`.
7202 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7203 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7204 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7209 .. code-block:: text
7211 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
7213 '``sub``' Instruction
7214 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7221 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7222 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7223 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7224 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7229 The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
7231 Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
7232 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
7237 The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
7238 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7239 arguments must have identical types.
7244 The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
7246 If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
7247 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
7250 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
7251 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
7253 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7254 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7255 result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7256 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7261 .. code-block:: text
7263 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
7264 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
7268 '``fsub``' Instruction
7269 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7276 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7281 The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
7286 The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be
7287 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7288 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7293 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two operands.
7294 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7295 environment <floatenv>`.
7296 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7297 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7298 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7303 .. code-block:: text
7305 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
7306 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
7308 '``mul``' Instruction
7309 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7316 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7317 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7318 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7319 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7324 The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7329 The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
7330 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7331 arguments must have identical types.
7336 The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
7338 If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
7339 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
7340 bit width of the result.
7342 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
7343 result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
7344 correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
7345 (e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
7346 sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
7349 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7350 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7351 result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7352 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7357 .. code-block:: text
7359 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
7363 '``fmul``' Instruction
7364 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7371 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7376 The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7381 The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be
7382 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7383 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7388 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two operands.
7389 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7390 environment <floatenv>`.
7391 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7392 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7393 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7398 .. code-block:: text
7400 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
7402 '``udiv``' Instruction
7403 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7410 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7411 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7416 The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7421 The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
7422 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7423 arguments must have identical types.
7428 The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
7430 Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
7431 distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
7433 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7434 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7437 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
7438 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
7439 such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
7444 .. code-block:: text
7446 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7448 '``sdiv``' Instruction
7449 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7456 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7457 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7462 The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7467 The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
7468 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7469 arguments must have identical types.
7474 The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
7475 rounded towards zero.
7477 Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
7478 distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
7480 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7481 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7482 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7483 occur, for example, by doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
7485 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
7486 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
7491 .. code-block:: text
7493 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7497 '``fdiv``' Instruction
7498 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7505 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7510 The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7515 The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be
7516 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7517 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7522 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two operands.
7523 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7524 environment <floatenv>`.
7525 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7526 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7527 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7532 .. code-block:: text
7534 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
7536 '``urem``' Instruction
7537 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7544 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7549 The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
7550 division of its two arguments.
7555 The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
7556 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7557 arguments must have identical types.
7562 This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
7563 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
7566 Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
7567 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
7569 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7570 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7576 .. code-block:: text
7578 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7580 '``srem``' Instruction
7581 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7588 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7593 The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
7594 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
7595 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
7601 The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
7602 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7603 arguments must have identical types.
7608 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
7609 is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
7610 *modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
7611 as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
7612 difference, see `The Math
7613 Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
7614 table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
7616 operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
7618 Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
7619 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
7621 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7622 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7624 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7625 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
7626 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
7627 rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
7628 result of the division and the remainder.)
7633 .. code-block:: text
7635 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7639 '``frem``' Instruction
7640 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7647 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7652 The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
7658 The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be
7659 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7660 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7665 The value produced is the floating-point remainder of the two operands.
7666 This is the same output as a libm '``fmod``' function, but without any
7667 possibility of setting ``errno``. The remainder has the same sign as the
7669 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7670 environment <floatenv>`.
7671 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7672 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7673 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7678 .. code-block:: text
7680 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
7684 Bitwise Binary Operations
7685 -------------------------
7687 Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
7688 in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
7689 commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
7690 operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
7691 single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
7693 '``shl``' Instruction
7694 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7701 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7702 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7703 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7704 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7709 The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
7710 a specified number of bits.
7715 Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
7716 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7717 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7722 The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
7723 where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
7724 dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
7725 ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
7726 If the arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted
7727 by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7729 If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7730 value if it shifts out any non-zero bits.
7731 If the ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7732 value if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the resultant sign bit.
7737 .. code-block:: text
7739 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
7740 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
7741 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
7742 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7743 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
7745 '``lshr``' Instruction
7746 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7753 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7754 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7759 The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
7760 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
7765 Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
7766 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7767 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7772 This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
7773 most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
7774 the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
7775 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7776 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7777 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7779 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
7780 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
7785 .. code-block:: text
7787 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7788 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7789 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7790 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
7791 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7792 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
7794 '``ashr``' Instruction
7795 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7802 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7803 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7808 The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
7809 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
7815 Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
7816 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7817 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7822 This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
7823 The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
7824 of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
7825 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7826 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7827 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7829 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
7830 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
7835 .. code-block:: text
7837 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7838 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7839 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7840 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
7841 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7842 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
7844 '``and``' Instruction
7845 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7852 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7857 The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
7863 The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
7864 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7865 arguments must have identical types.
7870 The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
7887 .. code-block:: text
7889 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
7890 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
7891 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
7893 '``or``' Instruction
7894 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7901 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7906 The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
7912 The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
7913 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7914 arguments must have identical types.
7919 The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
7938 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
7939 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
7940 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
7942 '``xor``' Instruction
7943 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7950 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7955 The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
7956 its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
7957 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
7962 The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
7963 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7964 arguments must have identical types.
7969 The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
7986 .. code-block:: text
7988 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
7989 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
7990 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
7991 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
7996 LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
7997 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
7998 and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
7999 While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
8000 sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
8001 take full advantage of a specific target.
8003 .. _i_extractelement:
8005 '``extractelement``' Instruction
8006 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8013 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
8018 The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
8019 from a vector at a specified index.
8024 The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
8025 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
8026 the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
8027 variable of any integer type.
8032 The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
8033 Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
8034 exceeds the length of ``val``, the result is a
8035 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8040 .. code-block:: text
8042 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
8044 .. _i_insertelement:
8046 '``insertelement``' Instruction
8047 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8054 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
8059 The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
8060 vector at a specified index.
8065 The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
8066 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
8067 type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
8068 is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
8069 index may be a variable of any integer type.
8074 The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
8075 are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
8076 ``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the result
8077 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8082 .. code-block:: text
8084 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
8086 .. _i_shufflevector:
8088 '``shufflevector``' Instruction
8089 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8096 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
8101 The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
8102 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
8103 the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
8108 The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
8109 with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
8110 type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
8111 length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
8112 same as the element type of the first two operands.
8114 The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
8115 constant integer or undef values.
8120 The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
8121 across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
8122 element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
8123 result element gets. If the shuffle mask is undef, the result vector is
8124 undef. If any element of the mask operand is undef, that element of the
8125 result is undef. If the shuffle mask selects an undef element from one
8126 of the input vectors, the resulting element is undef.
8131 .. code-block:: text
8133 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
8134 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
8135 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
8136 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
8137 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
8138 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
8139 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
8140 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
8142 Aggregate Operations
8143 --------------------
8145 LLVM supports several instructions for working with
8146 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
8150 '``extractvalue``' Instruction
8151 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8158 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
8163 The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
8164 from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
8169 The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
8170 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
8171 constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
8172 as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
8174 The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
8176 - Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
8177 omitted and assumed to be zero.
8178 - At least one index must be specified.
8179 - Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
8184 The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
8190 .. code-block:: text
8192 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
8196 '``insertvalue``' Instruction
8197 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8204 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
8209 The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
8210 an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
8215 The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
8216 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
8217 a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
8218 indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
8219 similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
8220 to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
8226 The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
8227 that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
8228 indices is that of ``elt``.
8233 .. code-block:: llvm
8235 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
8236 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
8237 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
8241 Memory Access and Addressing Operations
8242 ---------------------------------------
8244 A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
8245 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
8246 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
8251 '``alloca``' Instruction
8252 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8259 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] [, addrspace(<num>)] ; yields type addrspace(num)*:result
8264 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
8265 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
8266 function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
8267 address space for allocas indicated in the datalayout.
8272 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
8273 bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
8274 appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
8275 the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
8276 to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
8277 allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
8278 alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
8279 zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
8280 boundary compatible with the type.
8282 '``type``' may be any sized type.
8287 Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
8288 if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
8289 memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
8290 '``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
8291 variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
8292 (either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
8293 reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the returned pointer may not
8294 be unique. The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack
8295 grows) is not specified.
8300 .. code-block:: llvm
8302 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8303 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
8304 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
8305 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
8309 '``load``' Instruction
8310 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8317 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
8318 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
8319 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
8320 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
8321 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
8326 The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
8331 The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address from which
8332 to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
8333 known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>`). If
8334 the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to
8335 modify the number or order of execution of this ``load`` with other
8336 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8338 If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8339 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8340 ``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions.
8341 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8342 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8343 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8344 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8345 explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the
8346 alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8347 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
8349 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8350 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8351 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8352 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8353 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8354 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
8355 may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
8356 maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment value higher
8357 than the size of the loaded type implies memory up to the alignment
8358 value bytes can be safely loaded without trapping in the default
8359 address space. Access of the high bytes can interfere with debugging
8360 tools, so should not be accessed if the function has the
8361 ``sanitize_thread`` or ``sanitize_address`` attributes.
8363 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
8364 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8365 ``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
8366 metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
8367 that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
8368 generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
8369 as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
8371 The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
8372 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8373 entries. If a load instruction tagged with the ``!invariant.load``
8374 metadata is executed, the optimizer may assume the memory location
8375 referenced by the load contains the same value at all points in the
8376 program where the memory location is known to be dereferenceable;
8377 otherwise, the behavior is undefined.
8379 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8380 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no entries.
8381 See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8383 The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
8384 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8385 entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
8386 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
8387 never be null. If the value is null at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8388 This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute on parameters and return
8389 values. This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
8391 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8392 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
8393 entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
8394 tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
8395 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
8396 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
8397 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
8398 to loads of a pointer type.
8400 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
8401 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8402 ``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
8403 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
8404 dereferenceable or null.
8405 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
8406 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
8407 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
8408 to loads of a pointer type.
8410 The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8411 ``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
8412 The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
8413 optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
8414 by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
8415 This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
8416 This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type. If the returned
8417 value is not appropriately aligned at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8422 The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
8423 is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
8424 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8425 example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
8426 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8427 of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
8428 written using a store of the same type.
8433 .. code-block:: llvm
8435 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8436 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8437 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8441 '``store``' Instruction
8442 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8449 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8450 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8455 The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
8460 There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store and an
8461 address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` operand must be a
8462 pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of the ``<value>``
8463 operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8464 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this ``store`` with other
8465 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. Only values of :ref:`first class
8466 <t_firstclass>` types of known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque
8467 structural type <t_opaque>`) can be stored.
8469 If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8470 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8471 ``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions.
8472 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8473 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8474 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8475 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8476 explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if
8477 the alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8478 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
8480 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8481 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8482 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8483 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8484 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8485 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
8486 alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
8487 safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment
8488 value higher than the size of the stored type implies memory up to the
8489 alignment value bytes can be stored to without trapping in the default
8490 address space. Storing to the higher bytes however may result in data
8491 races if another thread can access the same address. Introducing a
8492 data race is not allowed. Storing to the extra bytes is not allowed
8493 even in situations where a data race is known to not exist if the
8494 function has the ``sanitize_address`` attribute.
8496 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8497 name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
8498 value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
8499 tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
8500 be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
8501 instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on
8504 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
8505 single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8510 The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
8511 location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
8512 of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
8513 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8514 example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
8515 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8516 of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
8517 belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
8522 .. code-block:: llvm
8524 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8525 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8526 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8530 '``fence``' Instruction
8531 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8538 fence [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields void
8543 The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
8549 '``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
8550 defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
8551 ``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
8556 A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
8557 *synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
8558 semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
8559 operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
8560 modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
8561 headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
8562 *happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
8563 ``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
8564 provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
8565 still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
8566 *happens-before* edge.
8568 A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
8569 ``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
8570 the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
8572 A ``fence`` instruction can also take an optional
8573 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8578 .. code-block:: text
8580 fence acquire ; yields void
8581 fence syncscope("singlethread") seq_cst ; yields void
8582 fence syncscope("agent") seq_cst ; yields void
8586 '``cmpxchg``' Instruction
8587 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8594 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
8599 The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
8600 loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
8601 equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
8606 There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
8607 to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
8608 address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
8609 are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer or pointer type whose
8610 bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
8611 than or equal to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must
8612 have the same type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to
8613 that type. If the ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the
8614 optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
8615 this ``cmpxchg`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8617 The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
8618 ``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
8619 must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
8620 stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
8621 ``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
8623 A ``cmpxchg`` instruction can also take an optional
8624 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8626 The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
8627 equal to the size in memory of the operand.
8632 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
8633 is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the values are equal, '``<new>``' is
8634 written to the location. The original value at the location is returned,
8635 together with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
8637 If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
8638 permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
8641 If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
8642 if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
8644 A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
8645 identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
8646 load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
8651 .. code-block:: llvm
8654 %orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
8658 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
8659 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
8660 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
8661 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
8662 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
8663 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
8670 '``atomicrmw``' Instruction
8671 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8678 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields ty
8683 The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
8688 There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
8689 operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
8690 operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
8706 For most of these operations, the type of '<value>' must be an integer
8707 type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight
8708 and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. For xchg, this
8709 may also be a floating point type with the same size constraints as
8710 integers. For fadd/fsub, this must be a floating point type. The
8711 type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must be a pointer to that type. If
8712 the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8713 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this
8714 ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8716 A ``atomicrmw`` instruction can also take an optional
8717 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8722 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
8723 operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
8724 value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
8727 - xchg: ``*ptr = val``
8728 - add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
8729 - sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
8730 - and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
8731 - nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
8732 - or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
8733 - xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
8734 - max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8735 - min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8736 - umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8738 - umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8740 - fadd: ``*ptr = *ptr + val`` (using floating point arithmetic)
8741 - fsub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val`` (using floating point arithmetic)
8746 .. code-block:: llvm
8748 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
8750 .. _i_getelementptr:
8752 '``getelementptr``' Instruction
8753 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8760 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8761 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8762 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, [inrange] <vector index type> <idx>
8767 The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
8768 subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
8769 address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
8770 be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
8775 The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
8776 The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
8777 base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
8778 that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
8779 The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
8780 into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
8781 second argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
8782 (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
8783 can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
8784 value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
8785 subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
8786 would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
8788 The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
8789 When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
8790 **constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
8791 be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
8792 pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
8793 required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
8796 For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
8812 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
8813 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
8816 The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
8818 .. code-block:: llvm
8820 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
8821 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
8823 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
8825 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
8832 In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
8833 '``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
8834 = '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
8835 indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
8836 '``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
8837 structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
8838 structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
8839 dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
8840 type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
8841 element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
8843 Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
8844 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
8845 for the given testcase is equivalent to:
8847 .. code-block:: llvm
8849 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
8850 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
8851 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
8852 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
8853 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
8854 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
8858 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
8859 ``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
8860 pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
8861 of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
8862 offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
8863 precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
8864 allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
8865 all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
8866 past the end. The only *in bounds* address for a null pointer in the
8867 default address-space is the null pointer itself. In cases where the
8868 base is a vector of pointers the ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each
8869 of the computations element-wise.
8871 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
8872 base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
8873 offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
8874 or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
8875 ``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
8876 pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
8877 though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
8878 :ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
8881 If the ``inrange`` keyword is present before any index, loading from or
8882 storing to any pointer derived from the ``getelementptr`` has undefined
8883 behavior if the load or store would access memory outside of the bounds of
8884 the element selected by the index marked as ``inrange``. The result of a
8885 pointer comparison or ``ptrtoint`` (including ``ptrtoint``-like operations
8886 involving memory) involving a pointer derived from a ``getelementptr`` with
8887 the ``inrange`` keyword is undefined, with the exception of comparisons
8888 in the case where both operands are in the range of the element selected
8889 by the ``inrange`` keyword, inclusive of the address one past the end of
8890 that element. Note that the ``inrange`` keyword is currently only allowed
8891 in constant ``getelementptr`` expressions.
8893 The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
8894 into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
8899 .. code-block:: llvm
8901 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
8902 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
8904 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
8906 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
8908 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
8913 The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
8914 when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
8915 arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
8916 will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
8918 .. code-block:: llvm
8920 ; All arguments are vectors:
8921 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
8922 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
8924 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
8925 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
8926 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
8928 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
8929 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
8930 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
8932 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
8934 The two following instructions are equivalent:
8936 .. code-block:: llvm
8938 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
8939 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
8940 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
8942 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
8944 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
8945 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
8947 Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
8952 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
8953 double *A, *B; int *C;
8954 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
8958 .. code-block:: llvm
8960 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
8961 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
8962 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
8963 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64.v8p0f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
8964 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
8966 Conversion Operations
8967 ---------------------
8969 The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
8970 (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
8971 various bit conversions on the operand.
8975 '``trunc .. to``' Instruction
8976 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8983 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8988 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
8993 The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
8994 it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
8995 of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8996 larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
8997 types are not allowed.
9002 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
9003 and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
9004 be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
9005 It will always truncate bits.
9010 .. code-block:: llvm
9012 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
9013 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
9014 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
9015 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
9019 '``zext .. to``' Instruction
9020 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9027 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9032 The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
9037 The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
9038 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
9039 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9040 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9045 The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
9046 until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9048 When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
9053 .. code-block:: llvm
9055 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
9056 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
9057 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
9061 '``sext .. to``' Instruction
9062 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9069 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9074 The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
9079 The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
9080 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
9081 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
9082 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
9087 The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
9088 bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
9089 of the type ``ty2``.
9091 When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
9096 .. code-block:: llvm
9098 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
9099 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
9100 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
9102 '``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
9103 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9110 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9115 The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
9120 The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9121 value to cast and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
9122 The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
9123 implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
9128 The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
9129 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating-point
9131 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
9132 environment <floatenv>`.
9137 .. code-block:: llvm
9139 %X = fptrunc double 16777217.0 to float ; yields float:16777216.0
9140 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to half ; yields half:+infinity
9142 '``fpext .. to``' Instruction
9143 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9150 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9155 The '``fpext``' extends a floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point
9161 The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9162 ``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it
9163 to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
9168 The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
9169 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating-point
9170 <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
9171 *no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
9172 *no-op cast* for a floating-point cast.
9177 .. code-block:: llvm
9179 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
9180 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
9182 '``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
9183 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9190 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9195 The '``fptoui``' converts a floating-point ``value`` to its unsigned
9196 integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
9201 The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9202 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
9203 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
9204 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
9205 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9210 The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
9211 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
9212 unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
9213 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
9218 .. code-block:: llvm
9220 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
9221 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
9222 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
9224 '``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
9225 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9232 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9237 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
9238 ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
9243 The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9244 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
9245 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
9246 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
9247 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9252 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
9253 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
9254 signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
9255 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
9260 .. code-block:: llvm
9262 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
9263 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
9264 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
9266 '``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
9267 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9274 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9279 The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
9280 and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9285 The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9286 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9287 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9288 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9289 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9294 The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
9295 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point
9296 value. If the value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using
9297 the default rounding mode.
9303 .. code-block:: llvm
9305 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9306 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
9308 '``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
9309 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9316 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9321 The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
9322 converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9327 The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9328 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9329 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9330 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9331 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9336 The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
9337 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point value. If the
9338 value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using the default rounding
9344 .. code-block:: llvm
9346 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9347 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
9351 '``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
9352 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9359 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9364 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
9365 pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
9370 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
9371 a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
9372 type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9373 a vector of integers type.
9378 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
9379 ``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
9380 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
9381 If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
9382 ``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
9383 the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
9389 .. code-block:: llvm
9391 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9392 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
9393 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
9397 '``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
9398 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9405 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9410 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
9411 pointer type, ``ty2``.
9416 The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
9417 cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
9423 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
9424 applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
9425 of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
9426 pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
9427 of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
9428 nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
9433 .. code-block:: llvm
9435 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
9436 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
9437 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9438 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
9442 '``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
9443 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9450 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9455 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
9461 The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9462 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
9463 also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
9464 bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
9465 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
9466 also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
9467 conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
9468 long as they have the same size).
9473 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
9474 is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
9475 conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
9476 to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
9477 pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
9478 pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
9479 To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
9480 or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
9485 .. code-block:: text
9487 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
9488 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
9489 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
9490 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
9492 .. _i_addrspacecast:
9494 '``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
9495 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9502 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
9507 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
9508 address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
9513 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
9514 to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
9520 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
9521 ``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
9522 value modification, depending on the target and the address space
9523 pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
9524 performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
9525 conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
9531 .. code-block:: llvm
9533 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
9534 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
9535 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
9542 The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
9543 which defy better classification.
9547 '``icmp``' Instruction
9548 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9555 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9560 The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
9561 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
9562 pointer, or pointer vector operands.
9567 The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9568 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9569 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9572 #. ``ne``: not equal
9573 #. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
9574 #. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
9575 #. ``ult``: unsigned less than
9576 #. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
9577 #. ``sgt``: signed greater than
9578 #. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
9579 #. ``slt``: signed less than
9580 #. ``sle``: signed less or equal
9582 The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9583 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
9584 must also be identical types.
9589 The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
9590 code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
9591 :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
9593 #. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
9594 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9595 #. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
9596 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9597 #. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9598 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9599 #. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9600 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9601 #. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9602 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9603 #. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9604 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9605 #. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9606 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9607 #. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9608 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9609 #. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9610 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9611 #. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9612 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9614 If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
9615 are compared as if they were integers.
9617 If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
9618 element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
9619 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
9624 .. code-block:: text
9626 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9627 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
9628 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
9629 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9630 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9631 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9635 '``fcmp``' Instruction
9636 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9643 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9648 The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
9649 values based on comparison of its operands.
9651 If the operands are floating-point scalars, then the result type is a
9652 boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
9654 If the operands are floating-point vectors, then the result type is a
9655 vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
9661 The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9662 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9663 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9665 #. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
9666 #. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
9667 #. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
9668 #. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
9669 #. ``olt``: ordered and less than
9670 #. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
9671 #. ``one``: ordered and not equal
9672 #. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
9673 #. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
9674 #. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
9675 #. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
9676 #. ``ult``: unordered or less than
9677 #. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
9678 #. ``une``: unordered or not equal
9679 #. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
9680 #. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
9682 *Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
9683 that either operand may be a QNAN.
9685 Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating-point
9686 <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating-point type.
9687 They must have identical types.
9692 The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
9693 condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
9694 vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
9695 always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
9697 #. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
9698 #. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9699 is equal to ``op2``.
9700 #. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9701 is greater than ``op2``.
9702 #. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9703 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9704 #. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9705 is less than ``op2``.
9706 #. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9707 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9708 #. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9709 is not equal to ``op2``.
9710 #. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
9711 #. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9713 #. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9714 greater than ``op2``.
9715 #. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9716 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9717 #. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9719 #. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9720 less than or equal to ``op2``.
9721 #. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9722 not equal to ``op2``.
9723 #. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
9724 #. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
9726 The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
9727 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9728 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations.
9730 Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
9731 only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
9732 assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
9733 ``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``reassoc``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
9738 .. code-block:: text
9740 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
9741 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9742 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9743 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
9747 '``phi``' Instruction
9748 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9755 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
9760 The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
9761 graph representing the function.
9766 The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
9767 After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
9768 arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
9769 block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
9770 the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
9773 There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
9774 and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
9777 For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
9778 deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
9779 the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
9780 instruction's return value on the same edge).
9785 At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
9786 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
9787 executed just prior to the current block.
9792 .. code-block:: llvm
9794 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
9795 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
9796 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
9801 '``select``' Instruction
9802 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9809 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
9811 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
9816 The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
9817 condition, without IR-level branching.
9822 The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
9823 values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
9824 class <t_firstclass>` type.
9829 If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
9830 the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
9833 If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
9834 vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
9836 If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
9837 same size, then an entire vector is selected.
9842 .. code-block:: llvm
9844 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
9848 '``call``' Instruction
9849 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9856 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)]
9857 [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs] [ operand bundles ]
9862 The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
9867 This instruction requires several arguments:
9869 #. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
9870 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
9871 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
9872 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
9873 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
9875 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
9876 recursive cycle in the call graph.
9877 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
9880 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas from the caller.
9881 The ``tail`` marker additionally implies that the callee does not access
9882 varargs from the caller, while ``musttail`` implies that varargs from the
9883 caller are passed to the callee. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the
9884 following additional rules:
9886 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
9887 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
9888 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
9889 produced by the call or void.
9890 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
9891 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
9893 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
9894 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
9895 returned, and inalloca, must match.
9896 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
9897 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
9898 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
9900 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
9901 the following conditions are met:
9903 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
9904 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
9905 uses value of call or is void).
9906 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
9907 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
9908 - `Platform-specific constraints are
9909 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
9911 #. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
9912 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
9913 call optimization from being performed on the call.
9915 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more
9916 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9917 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
9918 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
9920 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
9921 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
9922 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
9923 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
9924 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
9925 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
9926 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
9928 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the address space
9929 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
9930 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
9931 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
9932 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
9934 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
9935 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
9936 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
9937 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
9938 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
9939 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
9941 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
9942 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
9943 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
9944 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
9945 extra arguments can be specified.
9946 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
9947 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
9952 The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
9953 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
9954 values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
9955 flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
9956 return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
9961 .. code-block:: llvm
9963 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
9964 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
9965 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
9966 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
9967 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
9969 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
9970 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
9971 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
9972 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
9973 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
9974 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
9976 llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
9977 the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
9978 perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
9979 This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
9980 support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
9984 '``va_arg``' Instruction
9985 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9992 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
9997 The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
9998 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
9999 the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
10004 This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
10005 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
10006 increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
10007 type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
10012 The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
10013 from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
10014 the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
10015 handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
10017 It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
10018 not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
10021 ``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
10022 function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
10027 See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
10029 Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
10030 targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
10031 types on any target.
10035 '``landingpad``' Instruction
10036 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10043 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
10044 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
10046 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
10047 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
10052 The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10053 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10054 is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
10055 code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
10056 defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
10057 re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
10063 ``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
10065 A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
10066 contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
10067 or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
10068 clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
10069 "``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
10070 '``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
10071 the ``cleanup`` flag.
10076 The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
10077 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
10078 therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
10079 calling conventions, how the personality function results are
10080 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
10082 The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
10083 ``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
10084 clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
10085 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
10086 the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
10087 match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
10088 unwinding continues further up the call stack.
10090 The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
10092 - A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
10093 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
10094 - A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
10095 first non-PHI instruction.
10096 - There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
10098 - A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
10099 '``landingpad``' instruction.
10104 .. code-block:: llvm
10106 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
10107 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10109 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
10110 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10112 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
10113 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
10115 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
10119 '``catchpad``' Instruction
10120 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10127 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
10132 The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10133 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10134 begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
10135 control to catch an exception.
10140 The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
10141 :ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
10142 ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
10143 terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
10145 The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
10146 requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
10147 will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
10150 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
10151 ``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
10157 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
10158 exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
10159 not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
10160 entirely target and personality function-specific.
10162 Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
10163 instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
10165 The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
10166 instructions is described in the
10167 `Windows exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`_.
10169 When a ``catchpad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
10170 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
10171 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
10172 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
10177 .. code-block:: text
10180 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
10181 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
10183 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
10187 '``cleanuppad``' Instruction
10188 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10195 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
10200 The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
10201 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
10202 is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
10203 transfer control to run cleanup actions.
10204 The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
10205 information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
10206 execute the cleanup.
10207 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
10208 match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
10209 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
10210 ``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
10211 this operand may be the token ``none``.
10216 The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
10217 by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
10222 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
10223 the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
10224 ``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
10225 As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
10226 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
10228 The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
10230 - A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
10231 an exceptional instruction.
10232 - A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
10233 first non-PHI instruction.
10234 - There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
10236 - A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
10237 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
10239 When a ``cleanuppad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
10240 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
10241 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
10242 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
10247 .. code-block:: text
10249 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
10253 Intrinsic Functions
10254 ===================
10256 LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
10257 have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
10258 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
10259 for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
10260 transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
10261 reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
10263 Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
10264 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
10265 not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
10266 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
10267 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
10268 to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
10269 intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
10270 are added that they be documented here.
10272 Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
10273 represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
10274 different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
10275 different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
10276 intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
10277 argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
10278 integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
10279 previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
10280 function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
10281 of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
10282 argument or the result.
10284 Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
10285 types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
10286 those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
10287 whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
10288 ``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
10289 integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
10290 functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
10291 ``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
10292 overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
10293 type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
10296 To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
10297 LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
10301 Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
10302 -------------------------------------
10304 Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
10305 :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
10306 functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
10307 defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
10309 All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
10310 value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
10311 does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
10312 prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
10314 This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
10315 variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
10317 .. code-block:: llvm
10319 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
10320 ; it is merely an i8*.
10321 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
10323 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
10324 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
10326 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
10327 ; Initialize variable argument processing
10328 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
10329 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
10330 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
10332 ; Read a single integer argument
10333 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
10335 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
10337 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
10338 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
10339 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
10341 ; Stop processing of arguments.
10342 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
10346 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
10347 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
10348 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
10352 '``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
10353 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10360 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
10365 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
10366 subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
10371 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10376 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
10377 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
10378 ``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
10379 to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
10380 function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
10381 to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
10384 '``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
10385 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10392 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
10397 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
10398 initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
10403 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
10408 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
10409 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
10410 element to which the argument points. Calls to
10411 :ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
10412 :ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
10417 '``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
10418 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10425 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
10430 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
10431 from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
10436 The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10437 The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
10442 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
10443 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
10444 ``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
10445 intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
10446 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
10448 Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
10449 --------------------------------------
10451 LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
10452 (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
10453 calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
10454 intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
10456 These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
10457 stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
10458 require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
10459 Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
10460 these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
10461 details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
10463 Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
10464 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10466 LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
10467 collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
10468 to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
10469 :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
10470 differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
10471 <GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
10472 described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
10476 '``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
10477 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10484 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
10489 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
10490 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
10495 The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
10496 the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
10497 a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
10503 At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
10504 "ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
10505 information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
10506 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
10507 :ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
10511 '``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
10512 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10519 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
10524 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
10525 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
10531 The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
10532 address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
10533 pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
10534 runtime (otherwise null).
10539 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
10540 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10541 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
10542 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10547 '``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
10548 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10555 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
10560 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
10561 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
10562 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
10567 The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
10568 the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
10569 Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
10570 object, Obj may be null.
10575 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
10576 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10577 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
10578 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10581 Code Generator Intrinsics
10582 -------------------------
10584 These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
10585 may only be implemented with code generator support.
10587 '``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
10588 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10595 declare i8* @llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
10600 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
10601 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
10602 function or one of its callers.
10607 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10608 address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
10609 caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10615 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10616 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10617 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10618 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10619 used for debugging purposes.
10621 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10622 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10623 of the obvious source-language caller.
10625 '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' Intrinsic
10626 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10633 declare i8* @llvm.addressofreturnaddress()
10638 The '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' intrinsic returns a target-specific
10639 pointer to the place in the stack frame where the return address of the
10640 current function is stored.
10645 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10646 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10647 of the obvious source-language caller.
10649 This intrinsic is only implemented for x86 and aarch64.
10651 '``llvm.sponentry``' Intrinsic
10652 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10659 declare i8* @llvm.sponentry()
10664 The '``llvm.sponentry``' intrinsic returns the stack pointer value at
10665 the entry of the current function calling this intrinsic.
10670 Note this intrinsic is only verified on AArch64.
10672 '``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
10673 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10680 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
10685 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
10686 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
10691 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10692 frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
10693 its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10699 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10700 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10701 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10702 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10703 used for debugging purposes.
10705 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10706 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10707 of the obvious source-language caller.
10709 '``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
10710 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10717 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
10718 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
10723 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
10724 allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
10725 live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
10726 computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
10731 All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
10732 casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
10733 once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
10735 The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
10736 bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
10737 generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
10740 The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
10741 call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
10742 is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
10743 pointer in platform-specific ways.
10745 The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
10746 '``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
10751 These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
10752 stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
10753 '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
10754 child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
10755 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
10756 the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
10757 '``llvm.localrecover``'.
10759 .. _int_read_register:
10760 .. _int_write_register:
10762 '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
10763 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10770 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
10771 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
10772 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
10773 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
10779 The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
10780 provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
10781 the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
10782 with the register being read.
10787 The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
10788 register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
10789 the current value of the register, where possible.
10791 This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
10792 to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
10793 bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
10795 The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
10796 register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
10797 allocatable registers are not supported.
10799 Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
10800 architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
10801 work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
10806 '``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
10807 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10814 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
10819 The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
10820 of the function stack, for use with
10821 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
10822 implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
10828 This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
10829 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
10830 ``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
10831 ``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
10832 the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
10833 practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
10834 were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
10836 .. _int_stackrestore:
10838 '``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
10839 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10846 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
10851 The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
10852 the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
10853 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
10854 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
10855 sized arrays in C99.
10860 See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
10862 .. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
10864 '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
10865 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10872 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
10873 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
10878 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
10879 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
10880 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
10881 intendend for use in combination with
10882 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
10883 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
10884 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
10889 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
10890 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
10891 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
10892 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
10893 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
10894 complicated, because subtracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
10895 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
10897 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
10898 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
10899 compile-time-known constant value.
10901 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
10902 must match the target's default address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
10904 '``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
10905 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10912 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
10917 The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
10918 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
10919 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
10920 its performance characteristics.
10925 ``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
10926 determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
10927 ``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
10928 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
10929 specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
10930 instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
10931 arguments must be constant integers.
10936 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
10937 particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
10938 targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
10939 the processor cache for better performance.
10941 '``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
10942 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10949 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
10954 The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
10955 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
10956 method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
10957 exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
10958 guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
10959 optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
10960 optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
10961 allow correlations of simulation runs.
10966 ``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
10971 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
10972 that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
10974 '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
10975 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10982 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
10987 The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
10988 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
10989 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
10990 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
10991 order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
10997 When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
10998 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
10999 specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
11000 is lowered to a constant 0.
11002 Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
11003 running at and the host platform.
11005 '``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
11006 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11013 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
11018 The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
11019 in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
11020 targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
11021 flushes the instruction cache.
11026 On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
11027 intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
11028 cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
11029 instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
11032 The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
11035 This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
11036 of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
11038 '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' Intrinsic
11039 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11046 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11047 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
11052 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
11053 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
11054 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
11055 program at runtime.
11060 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
11061 name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
11062 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
11064 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
11065 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
11066 the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
11067 error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
11068 ``instrprof.increment`` that refer to the same name.
11070 The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
11071 be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
11076 This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
11077 cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
11078 structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
11079 format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
11080 the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
11082 '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' Intrinsic
11083 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11090 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment.step(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11091 i32 <num-counters>,
11092 i32 <index>, i64 <step>)
11097 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' intrinsic is an extension to
11098 the '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic with an additional fifth
11099 argument to specify the step of the increment.
11103 The first four arguments are the same as '``llvm.instrprof.increment``'
11106 The last argument specifies the value of the increment of the counter variable.
11110 See description of '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' instrinsic.
11113 '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' Intrinsic
11114 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11121 declare void @llvm.instrprof.value.profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
11122 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
11128 The '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
11129 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
11130 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
11131 instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
11136 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
11137 name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
11138 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
11140 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
11141 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
11142 is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
11143 ``llvm.instrprof.*`` that refer to the same name.
11145 The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
11146 expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
11147 fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
11148 supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
11149 ``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
11150 ``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
11151 index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
11156 This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
11157 should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
11158 pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
11159 ``llvm.instrprof.value.profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
11160 runtime library with proper arguments.
11162 '``llvm.thread.pointer``' Intrinsic
11163 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11170 declare i8* @llvm.thread.pointer()
11175 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns the value of the thread
11181 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns a pointer to the TLS area
11182 for the current thread. The exact semantics of this value are target
11183 specific: it may point to the start of TLS area, to the end, or somewhere
11184 in the middle. Depending on the target, this intrinsic may read a register,
11185 call a helper function, read from an alternate memory space, or perform
11186 other operations necessary to locate the TLS area. Not all targets support
11189 Standard C Library Intrinsics
11190 -----------------------------
11192 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
11193 functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
11194 information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
11195 generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
11199 '``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
11200 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11205 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
11206 integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
11207 support all bit widths however.
11211 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11212 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11213 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11214 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11219 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11220 source location to the destination location.
11222 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
11223 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra isvolatile
11224 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
11229 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
11230 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
11231 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
11232 boolean indicating a volatile access.
11234 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11235 for the first and second arguments.
11237 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
11238 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11239 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11244 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11245 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
11246 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
11247 to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
11248 argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
11252 '``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
11253 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11258 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
11259 bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
11260 bit widths however.
11264 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11265 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11266 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
11267 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11272 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
11273 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
11274 '``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
11277 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
11278 intrinsics do not return a value, takes an extra isvolatile
11279 argument and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
11284 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
11285 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
11286 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
11287 boolean indicating a volatile access.
11289 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11290 for the first and second arguments.
11292 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
11293 is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
11294 not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11299 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
11300 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
11301 copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
11302 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
11303 otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
11307 '``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
11308 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11313 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
11314 bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
11315 support all bit widths.
11319 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
11320 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11321 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
11322 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
11327 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
11328 particular byte value.
11330 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
11331 intrinsic does not return a value and takes an extra volatile
11332 argument. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
11337 The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
11338 is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
11339 integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
11340 is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
11342 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11343 for the first arguments.
11345 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
11346 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11347 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11352 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
11353 at the destination location.
11355 '``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
11356 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11361 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
11362 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11367 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
11368 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
11369 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11370 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
11371 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11376 The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the square root of the specified value.
11381 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11386 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sqrt``' function but without
11387 trapping or setting ``errno``. For types specified by IEEE-754, the result
11388 matches a conforming libm implementation.
11390 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11391 using a less accurate calculation.
11393 '``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
11394 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11399 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
11400 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11405 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
11406 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
11407 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
11408 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11409 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11414 The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11415 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
11416 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating-point type is
11417 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
11422 The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
11423 raise to that power.
11428 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
11429 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
11431 '``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
11432 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11437 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
11438 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11443 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
11444 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
11445 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11446 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
11447 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11452 The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
11457 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11462 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sin``' function but without
11463 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11465 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11466 using a less accurate calculation.
11468 '``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
11469 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11474 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
11475 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11480 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
11481 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
11482 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11483 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
11484 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11489 The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
11494 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11499 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``cos``' function but without
11500 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11502 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11503 using a less accurate calculation.
11505 '``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
11506 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11511 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
11512 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11517 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
11518 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
11519 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
11520 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
11521 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
11526 The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11527 specified (positive or negative) power.
11532 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11537 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``pow``' function but without
11538 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11540 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11541 using a less accurate calculation.
11543 '``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
11544 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11549 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
11550 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11555 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
11556 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
11557 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11558 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
11559 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11564 The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e exponential of the specified
11570 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11575 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp``' function but without
11576 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11578 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11579 using a less accurate calculation.
11581 '``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
11582 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11587 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
11588 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11593 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
11594 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
11595 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11596 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11597 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11602 The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 exponential of the
11608 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11613 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp2``' function but without
11614 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11616 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11617 using a less accurate calculation.
11619 '``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
11620 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11625 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
11626 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11631 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
11632 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
11633 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11634 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
11635 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11640 The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e logarithm of the specified
11646 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11651 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log``' function but without
11652 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11654 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11655 using a less accurate calculation.
11657 '``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
11658 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11663 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
11664 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11669 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
11670 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
11671 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11672 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
11673 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11678 The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics compute the base-10 logarithm of the
11684 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11689 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log10``' function but without
11690 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11692 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11693 using a less accurate calculation.
11695 '``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
11696 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11701 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
11702 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11707 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
11708 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
11709 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11710 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11711 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11716 The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 logarithm of the specified
11722 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11727 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log2``' function but without
11728 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11730 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11731 using a less accurate calculation.
11733 '``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
11734 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11739 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
11740 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11745 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
11746 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
11747 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
11748 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
11749 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
11754 The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add operation.
11759 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11764 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``fma``' function but without
11765 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11767 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11768 using a less accurate calculation.
11770 '``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
11771 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11776 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
11777 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11782 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
11783 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
11784 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11785 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
11786 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11791 The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
11797 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11803 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
11804 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11806 '``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
11807 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11812 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
11813 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11818 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11819 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11820 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11821 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11822 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11827 The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
11834 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11840 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, except for handling of
11841 signaling NaNs. This match's the behavior of libm's fmin.
11843 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
11844 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
11845 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
11846 equal to both operands. This means that fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
11847 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
11849 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
11850 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
11851 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
11852 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
11853 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
11854 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
11857 '``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
11858 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11863 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
11864 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11869 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
11870 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11871 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11872 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11873 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11878 The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
11885 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11890 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum except for the handling of
11891 signaling NaNs. This matches the behavior of libm's fmax.
11893 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
11894 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
11895 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
11896 equal to both operands. This means that fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
11897 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
11899 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
11900 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
11901 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
11902 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
11903 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
11904 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
11906 '``llvm.minimum.*``' Intrinsic
11907 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11912 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minimum`` on any
11913 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11918 declare float @llvm.minimum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11919 declare double @llvm.minimum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11920 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minimum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11921 declare fp128 @llvm.minimum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11922 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minimum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11927 The '``llvm.minimum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
11928 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
11934 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11939 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the lesser
11940 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
11941 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
11944 '``llvm.maximum.*``' Intrinsic
11945 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11950 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maximum`` on any
11951 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11956 declare float @llvm.maximum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11957 declare double @llvm.maximum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11958 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maximum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11959 declare fp128 @llvm.maximum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11960 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maximum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11965 The '``llvm.maximum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
11966 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
11972 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11977 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the greater
11978 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
11979 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
11982 '``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
11983 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11988 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
11989 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11994 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
11995 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
11996 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
11997 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
11998 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
12003 The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
12004 first operand and the sign of the second operand.
12009 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12015 This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
12016 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12018 '``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
12019 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12024 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
12025 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12030 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
12031 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
12032 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12033 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
12034 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12039 The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
12044 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12050 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
12051 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12053 '``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
12054 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12059 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
12060 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12065 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
12066 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
12067 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12068 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
12069 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12074 The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
12079 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12085 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
12086 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12088 '``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
12089 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12094 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
12095 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12100 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
12101 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
12102 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12103 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
12104 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12109 The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12110 nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
12115 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12121 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
12122 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12124 '``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
12125 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12130 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
12131 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12136 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
12137 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
12138 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12139 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
12140 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12145 The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12146 nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
12147 operand isn't an integer.
12152 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12158 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
12159 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12161 '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
12162 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12167 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
12168 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12173 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
12174 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
12175 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12176 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
12177 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12182 The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12188 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12194 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
12195 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12197 '``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
12198 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12203 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
12204 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
12209 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
12210 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
12211 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
12212 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
12213 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
12218 The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
12224 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
12230 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
12231 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
12233 Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
12234 ---------------------------
12236 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
12237 operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
12239 '``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
12240 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12245 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
12250 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
12251 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
12252 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
12253 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.bitreverse.v4i32(<4 x i32> <id>)
12258 The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
12259 bitpattern of an integer value or vector of integer values; for example
12260 ``0b10110110`` becomes ``0b01101101``.
12265 The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an iN value that has bit
12266 ``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output. The vector
12267 intrinsics, such as ``llvm.bitreverse.v4i32``, operate on a per-element
12268 basis and the element order is not affected.
12270 '``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
12271 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12276 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
12277 integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
12281 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
12282 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
12283 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
12284 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.bswap.v4i32(<4 x i32> <id>)
12289 The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap an integer
12290 value or vector of integer values with an even number of bytes (positive
12291 multiple of 16 bits).
12296 The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
12297 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
12298 intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
12299 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
12300 returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
12301 ``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
12302 concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
12303 respectively). The vector intrinsics, such as ``llvm.bswap.v4i32``,
12304 operate on a per-element basis and the element order is not affected.
12306 '``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
12307 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12312 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
12313 bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
12314 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12318 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
12319 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
12320 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
12321 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
12322 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
12323 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
12328 The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
12334 The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
12335 integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
12336 match the argument type.
12341 The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
12342 each element of a vector.
12344 '``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
12345 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12350 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
12351 integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
12352 targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12356 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12357 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12358 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12359 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12360 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12361 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12366 The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12367 leading zeros in a variable.
12372 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12373 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12374 type must match the first argument type.
12376 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12377 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12378 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12379 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12380 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12385 The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
12386 zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
12387 ``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
12388 if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12389 ``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
12391 '``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
12392 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12397 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
12398 integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12399 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12403 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12404 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12405 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12406 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12407 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12408 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12413 The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12419 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12420 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12421 type must match the first argument type.
12423 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12424 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12425 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12426 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12427 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12432 The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
12433 zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
12434 then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
12435 ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12436 ``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
12440 '``llvm.fshl.*``' Intrinsic
12441 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12446 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshl`` on any
12447 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12448 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12452 declare i8 @llvm.fshl.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12453 declare i67 @llvm.fshl.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12454 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshl.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12459 The '``llvm.fshl``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift left:
12460 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12461 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted left, and the most
12462 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12463 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12464 to a rotate left operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12465 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12466 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12471 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12472 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12473 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12474 have the same type.
12479 .. code-block:: text
12481 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: msb_extract((concat(x, y) << (z % 8)), 8)
12482 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 128 (0b10000000)
12483 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 120 (0b01111000)
12484 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 0 (0b00000000)
12486 '``llvm.fshr.*``' Intrinsic
12487 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12492 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshr`` on any
12493 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12494 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12498 declare i8 @llvm.fshr.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12499 declare i67 @llvm.fshr.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12500 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshr.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12505 The '``llvm.fshr``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift right:
12506 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12507 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted right, and the least
12508 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12509 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12510 to a rotate right operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12511 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12512 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12517 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12518 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12519 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12520 have the same type.
12525 .. code-block:: text
12527 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: lsb_extract((concat(x, y) >> (z % 8)), 8)
12528 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 254 (0b11111110)
12529 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 225 (0b11100001)
12530 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 255 (0b11111111)
12532 Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
12533 -----------------------------------
12535 LLVM provides intrinsics for fast arithmetic overflow checking.
12537 Each of these intrinsics returns a two-element struct. The first
12538 element of this struct contains the result of the corresponding
12539 arithmetic operation modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
12540 the result. Therefore, for example, the first element of the struct
12541 returned by ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32`` is always the same as the
12542 result of a 32-bit ``add`` instruction with the same operands, where
12543 the ``add`` is *not* modified by an ``nsw`` or ``nuw`` flag.
12545 The second element of the result is an ``i1`` that is 1 if the
12546 arithmetic operation overflowed and 0 otherwise. An operation
12547 overflows if, for any values of its operands ``A`` and ``B`` and for
12548 any ``N`` larger than the operands' width, ``ext(A op B) to iN`` is
12549 not equal to ``(ext(A) to iN) op (ext(B) to iN)`` where ``ext`` is
12550 ``sext`` for signed overflow and ``zext`` for unsigned overflow, and
12551 ``op`` is the underlying arithmetic operation.
12553 The behavior of these intrinsics is well-defined for all argument
12556 '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12557 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12562 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
12563 on any integer bit width.
12567 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12568 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12569 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12574 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12575 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
12576 occurred during the signed summation.
12581 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12582 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12583 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12584 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12590 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12591 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
12592 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
12593 of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
12599 .. code-block:: llvm
12601 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12602 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12603 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12604 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12606 '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12607 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12612 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
12613 on any integer bit width.
12617 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12618 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12619 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12624 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12625 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
12626 occurred during the unsigned summation.
12631 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12632 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12633 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12634 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12640 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12641 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
12642 first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
12643 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
12648 .. code-block:: llvm
12650 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12651 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12652 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12653 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
12655 '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12656 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12661 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
12662 on any integer bit width.
12666 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12667 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12668 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12673 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12674 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12675 overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
12680 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12681 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12682 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12683 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12689 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12690 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
12691 first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
12692 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
12698 .. code-block:: llvm
12700 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12701 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12702 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12703 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12705 '``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12706 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12711 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
12712 on any integer bit width.
12716 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12717 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12718 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12723 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12724 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12725 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
12730 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12731 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12732 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12733 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12739 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12740 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
12741 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
12742 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
12748 .. code-block:: llvm
12750 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12751 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12752 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12753 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12755 '``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12756 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12761 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
12762 on any integer bit width.
12766 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12767 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12768 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12773 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12774 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12775 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
12780 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12781 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12782 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12783 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12789 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12790 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
12791 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
12792 of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
12798 .. code-block:: llvm
12800 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12801 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12802 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12803 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12805 '``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12806 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12811 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
12812 on any integer bit width.
12816 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12817 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12818 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12823 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12824 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12825 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
12830 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12831 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12832 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12833 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12839 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12840 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
12841 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
12842 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
12843 resulted in an overflow.
12848 .. code-block:: llvm
12850 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12851 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12852 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12853 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12855 Saturation Arithmetic Intrinsics
12856 ---------------------------------
12858 Saturation arithmetic is a version of arithmetic in which operations are
12859 limited to a fixed range between a minimum and maximum value. If the result of
12860 an operation is greater than the maximum value, the result is set (or
12861 "clamped") to this maximum. If it is below the minimum, it is clamped to this
12865 '``llvm.sadd.sat.*``' Intrinsics
12866 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12871 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.sat``
12872 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12876 declare i16 @llvm.sadd.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12877 declare i32 @llvm.sadd.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12878 declare i64 @llvm.sadd.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12879 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.sadd.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
12884 The '``llvm.sadd.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
12885 saturation addition on the 2 arguments.
12890 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
12891 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
12892 values that will undergo signed addition.
12897 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
12898 representable by the bit width of the arguments. The minimum value is the
12899 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
12905 .. code-block:: llvm
12907 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 1, i4 2) ; %res = 3
12908 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 5, i4 6) ; %res = 7
12909 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 2) ; %res = -2
12910 %res = call i4 @llvm.sadd.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 -5) ; %res = -8
12913 '``llvm.uadd.sat.*``' Intrinsics
12914 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12919 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.sat``
12920 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12924 declare i16 @llvm.uadd.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12925 declare i32 @llvm.uadd.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12926 declare i64 @llvm.uadd.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12927 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.uadd.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
12932 The '``llvm.uadd.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
12933 saturation addition on the 2 arguments.
12938 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
12939 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
12940 values that will undergo unsigned addition.
12945 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest unsigned value
12946 representable by the bit width of the arguments. Because this is an unsigned
12947 operation, the result will never saturate towards zero.
12953 .. code-block:: llvm
12955 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 1, i4 2) ; %res = 3
12956 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 5, i4 6) ; %res = 11
12957 %res = call i4 @llvm.uadd.sat.i4(i4 8, i4 8) ; %res = 15
12960 '``llvm.ssub.sat.*``' Intrinsics
12961 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12966 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.sat``
12967 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
12971 declare i16 @llvm.ssub.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12972 declare i32 @llvm.ssub.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12973 declare i64 @llvm.ssub.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12974 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.ssub.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
12979 The '``llvm.ssub.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
12980 saturation subtraction on the 2 arguments.
12985 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
12986 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
12987 values that will undergo signed subtraction.
12992 The maximum value this operation can clamp to is the largest signed value
12993 representable by the bit width of the arguments. The minimum value is the
12994 smallest signed value representable by this bit width.
13000 .. code-block:: llvm
13002 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 1) ; %res = 1
13003 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 6) ; %res = -4
13004 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 -4, i4 5) ; %res = -8
13005 %res = call i4 @llvm.ssub.sat.i4(i4 4, i4 -5) ; %res = 7
13008 '``llvm.usub.sat.*``' Intrinsics
13009 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13014 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.sat``
13015 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13019 declare i16 @llvm.usub.sat.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
13020 declare i32 @llvm.usub.sat.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
13021 declare i64 @llvm.usub.sat.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
13022 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.usub.sat.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b)
13027 The '``llvm.usub.sat``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13028 saturation subtraction on the 2 arguments.
13033 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13034 width, but they must have the same bit width. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13035 values that will undergo unsigned subtraction.
13040 The minimum value this operation can clamp to is 0, which is the smallest
13041 unsigned value representable by the bit width of the unsigned arguments.
13042 Because this is an unsigned operation, the result will never saturate towards
13043 the largest possible value representable by this bit width.
13049 .. code-block:: llvm
13051 %res = call i4 @llvm.usub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 1) ; %res = 1
13052 %res = call i4 @llvm.usub.sat.i4(i4 2, i4 6) ; %res = 0
13055 Fixed Point Arithmetic Intrinsics
13056 ---------------------------------
13058 A fixed point number represents a real data type for a number that has a fixed
13059 number of digits after a radix point (equivalent to the decimal point '.').
13060 The number of digits after the radix point is referred as the ``scale``. These
13061 are useful for representing fractional values to a specific precision. The
13062 following intrinsics perform fixed point arithmetic operations on 2 operands
13063 of the same scale, specified as the third argument.
13066 '``llvm.smul.fix.*``' Intrinsics
13067 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13072 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.fix``
13073 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13077 declare i16 @llvm.smul.fix.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13078 declare i32 @llvm.smul.fix.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13079 declare i64 @llvm.smul.fix.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13080 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.smul.fix.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13085 The '``llvm.smul.fix``' family of intrinsic functions perform signed
13086 fixed point multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13091 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13092 width, but they must have the same bit width. The arguments may also work with
13093 int vectors of the same length and int size. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13094 values that will undergo signed fixed point multiplication. The argument
13095 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13101 This operation performs fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13102 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13103 in the third argument.
13105 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13106 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13107 direction is unspecified.
13109 It is undefined behavior if the result value does not fit within the range of
13110 the fixed point type.
13116 .. code-block:: llvm
13118 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13119 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13120 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 -2, i32 1) ; %res = -3 (1.5 x -1 = -1.5)
13122 ; The result in the following could be rounded up to -2 or down to -2.5
13123 %res = call i4 @llvm.smul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 -3, i32 1) ; %res = -5 (or -4) (1.5 x -1.5 = -2.25)
13126 '``llvm.umul.fix.*``' Intrinsics
13127 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13132 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.fix``
13133 on any integer bit width or vectors of integers.
13137 declare i16 @llvm.umul.fix.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b, i32 %scale)
13138 declare i32 @llvm.umul.fix.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b, i32 %scale)
13139 declare i64 @llvm.umul.fix.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b, i32 %scale)
13140 declare <4 x i32> @llvm.umul.fix.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a, <4 x i32> %b, i32 %scale)
13145 The '``llvm.umul.fix``' family of intrinsic functions perform unsigned
13146 fixed point multiplication on 2 arguments of the same scale.
13151 The arguments (%a and %b) and the result may be of integer types of any bit
13152 width, but they must have the same bit width. The arguments may also work with
13153 int vectors of the same length and int size. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two
13154 values that will undergo unsigned fixed point multiplication. The argument
13155 ``%scale`` represents the scale of both operands, and must be a constant
13161 This operation performs unsigned fixed point multiplication on the 2 arguments of a
13162 specified scale. The result will also be returned in the same scale specified
13163 in the third argument.
13165 If the result value cannot be precisely represented in the given scale, the
13166 value is rounded up or down to the closest representable value. The rounding
13167 direction is unspecified.
13169 It is undefined behavior if the result value does not fit within the range of
13170 the fixed point type.
13176 .. code-block:: llvm
13178 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 0) ; %res = 6 (2 x 3 = 6)
13179 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 3, i4 2, i32 1) ; %res = 3 (1.5 x 1 = 1.5)
13181 ; The result in the following could be rounded down to 3.5 or up to 4
13182 %res = call i4 @llvm.umul.fix.i4(i4 15, i4 1, i32 1) ; %res = 7 (or 8) (7.5 x 0.5 = 3.75)
13185 Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
13186 ---------------------------------
13188 '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
13189 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13196 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
13197 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
13202 The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
13203 encoding of a floating-point number. This canonicalization is useful for
13204 implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
13205 defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
13209 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
13210 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
13211 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
13213 This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
13214 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
13215 according to section 6.2.
13217 Examples of non-canonical encodings:
13219 - x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
13220 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
13221 - Many normal decimal floating-point numbers have non-canonical alternative
13223 - Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
13224 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to
13225 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
13227 Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
13228 default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
13231 This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
13232 that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
13233 1.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
13234 -0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
13236 ``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
13238 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
13239 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
13242 Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
13243 ``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
13245 The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
13246 First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
13247 must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
13250 The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
13252 - The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
13253 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
13254 - The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
13255 operations. That is, the bits of the floating-point value are not examined.
13257 '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
13258 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13265 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
13266 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
13271 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
13272 expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
13273 target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
13274 fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
13275 and add instructions.
13280 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
13281 multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
13290 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
13292 is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
13293 not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
13294 code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
13295 the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
13296 corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
13297 instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
13302 .. code-block:: llvm
13304 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
13307 Experimental Vector Reduction Intrinsics
13308 ----------------------------------------
13310 Horizontal reductions of vectors can be expressed using the following
13311 intrinsics. Each one takes a vector operand as an input and applies its
13312 respective operation across all elements of the vector, returning a single
13313 scalar result of the same element type.
13316 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' Intrinsic
13317 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13324 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13325 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
13330 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``ADD``
13331 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13332 the element-type of the vector input.
13336 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13338 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' Intrinsic
13339 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13346 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
13347 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
13352 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13353 ``ADD`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13354 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13356 If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
13357 the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
13358 fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
13359 operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
13364 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
13365 only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
13366 when fast-math flags are used.
13368 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
13373 .. code-block:: llvm
13375 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
13376 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
13379 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' Intrinsic
13380 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13387 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13388 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
13393 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``MUL``
13394 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13395 the element-type of the vector input.
13399 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13401 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' Intrinsic
13402 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13409 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
13410 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
13415 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13416 ``MUL`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13417 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13419 If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
13420 the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
13421 fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
13422 operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
13427 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
13428 only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
13429 when fast-math flags are used.
13431 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
13436 .. code-block:: llvm
13438 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
13439 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
13441 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' Intrinsic
13442 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13449 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13454 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``AND``
13455 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13456 the element-type of the vector input.
13460 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13462 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' Intrinsic
13463 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13470 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13475 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``OR`` reduction
13476 of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches the
13477 element-type of the vector input.
13481 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13483 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' Intrinsic
13484 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13491 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13496 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``XOR``
13497 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
13498 the element-type of the vector input.
13502 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13504 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' Intrinsic
13505 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13512 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13517 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
13518 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13519 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13523 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13525 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' Intrinsic
13526 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13533 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13538 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
13539 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13540 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13544 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13546 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' Intrinsic
13547 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13554 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13559 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
13560 integer ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
13561 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
13565 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13567 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' Intrinsic
13568 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13575 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
13580 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
13581 integer ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
13582 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
13586 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
13588 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' Intrinsic
13589 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13596 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
13597 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
13602 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13603 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13604 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13606 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
13607 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
13611 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
13613 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' Intrinsic
13614 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13621 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
13622 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
13627 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
13628 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
13629 matches the element-type of the vector input.
13631 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
13632 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
13636 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
13638 Half Precision Floating-Point Intrinsics
13639 ----------------------------------------
13641 For most target platforms, half precision floating-point is a
13642 storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
13643 but does not support computation in the format.
13645 This means that code must first load the half-precision floating-point
13646 value as an i16, then convert it to float with
13647 :ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
13648 then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
13649 etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
13650 if needed, then converted to i16 with
13651 :ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
13654 .. _int_convert_to_fp16:
13656 '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
13657 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13664 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
13665 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
13670 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
13671 conventional floating-point type to half precision floating-point format.
13676 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
13682 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
13683 conventional floating-point format to half precision floating-point format. The
13684 return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
13689 .. code-block:: llvm
13691 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
13692 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
13694 .. _int_convert_from_fp16:
13696 '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
13697 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13704 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
13705 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
13710 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
13711 conversion from half precision floating-point format to single precision
13712 floating-point format.
13717 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
13723 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
13724 conversion from half single precision floating-point format to single
13725 precision floating-point format. The input half-float value is
13726 represented by an ``i16`` value.
13731 .. code-block:: llvm
13733 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
13734 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
13736 .. _dbg_intrinsics:
13738 Debugger Intrinsics
13739 -------------------
13741 The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
13742 prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
13743 Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_
13746 Exception Handling Intrinsics
13747 -----------------------------
13749 The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
13750 ``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
13751 Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_ document.
13753 .. _int_trampoline:
13755 Trampoline Intrinsics
13756 ---------------------
13758 These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
13759 the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
13760 callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
13761 not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
13762 in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
13763 stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
13764 argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
13767 For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
13768 then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
13769 It can be created as follows:
13771 .. code-block:: llvm
13773 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
13774 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
13775 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
13776 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
13777 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
13779 The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
13780 ``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
13784 '``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
13785 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13792 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
13797 This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
13798 turning it into a trampoline.
13803 The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
13804 pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
13805 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
13806 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
13807 LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
13808 front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
13809 target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
13810 bitcast to an ``i8*``.
13815 The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
13816 dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
13817 passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
13818 be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
13819 function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
13820 marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
13821 argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
13822 function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
13823 but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
13824 calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
13825 modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
13826 pointer is undefined.
13830 '``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
13831 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13838 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
13843 This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
13844 a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
13849 ``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
13850 code filled in by a previous call to
13851 :ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
13856 On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
13857 different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
13858 intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
13859 after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
13860 returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
13862 .. _int_mload_mstore:
13864 Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
13865 ---------------------------------------
13867 LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
13871 '``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
13872 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13876 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
13880 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
13881 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64.p0v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
13882 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
13883 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
13884 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
13885 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f.p0v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
13890 Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
13896 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
13902 The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
13903 The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
13908 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
13910 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
13911 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
13912 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
13916 '``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
13917 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13921 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
13925 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32.p0v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
13926 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
13927 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
13928 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
13929 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
13930 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f.p0v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
13935 Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
13940 The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
13946 The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
13947 The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
13951 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
13953 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
13954 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
13955 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
13956 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
13959 Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
13960 -------------------------------------------
13962 LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
13966 '``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
13967 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13971 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
13975 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32.v16p0f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
13976 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64.v2p1f64 (<2 x double addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
13977 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32.v8p0p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
13982 Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
13988 The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
13994 The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
13995 The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
14000 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1> <i1 true, i1 true, i1 true, i1 true>, <4 x double> undef)
14002 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
14003 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
14004 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
14005 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
14006 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
14008 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
14009 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
14010 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
14011 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
14013 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
14014 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
14015 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
14016 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
14020 '``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
14021 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14025 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
14029 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14030 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32.v16p1f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14031 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64.v4p0p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
14036 Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
14041 The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
14047 The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14051 ;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
14052 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
14054 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
14055 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
14056 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
14058 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
14059 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
14060 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
14062 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
14063 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
14064 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
14065 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
14067 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
14070 Masked Vector Expanding Load and Compressing Store Intrinsics
14071 -------------------------------------------------------------
14073 LLVM provides intrinsics for expanding load and compressing store operations. Data selected from a vector according to a mask is stored in consecutive memory addresses (compressed store), and vice-versa (expanding load). These operations effective map to "if (cond.i) a[j++] = v.i" and "if (cond.i) v.i = a[j++]" patterns, respectively. Note that when the mask starts with '1' bits followed by '0' bits, these operations are identical to :ref:`llvm.masked.store <int_mstore>` and :ref:`llvm.masked.load <int_mload>`.
14075 .. _int_expandload:
14077 '``llvm.masked.expandload.*``' Intrinsics
14078 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14082 This is an overloaded intrinsic. Several values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are loaded from consecutive memory addresses and stored into the elements of a vector according to the mask.
14086 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.expandload.v16f32 (float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
14087 declare <2 x i64> @llvm.masked.expandload.v2i64 (i64* <ptr>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x i64> <passthru>)
14092 Reads a number of scalar values sequentially from memory location provided in '``ptr``' and spreads them in a vector. The '``mask``' holds a bit for each vector lane. The number of elements read from memory is equal to the number of '1' bits in the mask. The loaded elements are positioned in the destination vector according to the sequence of '1' and '0' bits in the mask. E.g., if the mask vector is '10010001', "explandload" reads 3 values from memory addresses ptr, ptr+1, ptr+2 and places them in lanes 0, 3 and 7 accordingly. The masked-off lanes are filled by elements from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
14098 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. It has the same underlying type as the element of the returned vector. The second operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The third is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type and the type of the '``passthru``' operand have the same vector type.
14103 The '``llvm.masked.expandload``' intrinsic is designed for reading multiple scalar values from adjacent memory addresses into possibly non-adjacent vector lanes. It is useful for targets that support vector expanding loads and allows vectorizing loop with cross-iteration dependency like in the following example:
14107 // In this loop we load from B and spread the elements into array A.
14108 double *A, B; int *C;
14109 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
14115 .. code-block:: llvm
14117 ; Load several elements from array B and expand them in a vector.
14118 ; The number of loaded elements is equal to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14119 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.expandload.v8f64(double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
14120 ; Store the result in A
14121 call void @llvm.masked.store.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, <8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask)
14123 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14124 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
14125 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
14126 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
14127 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
14130 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of conditional scalar load operations and shuffles.
14131 If all mask elements are '1', the intrinsic behavior is equivalent to the regular unmasked vector load.
14133 .. _int_compressstore:
14135 '``llvm.masked.compressstore.*``' Intrinsics
14136 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14140 This is an overloaded intrinsic. A number of scalar values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are collected from an input vector and stored into adjacent memory addresses. A mask defines which elements to collect from the vector.
14144 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, i32* <ptr>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
14145 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
14150 Selects elements from input vector '``value``' according to the '``mask``'. All selected elements are written into adjacent memory addresses starting at address '`ptr`', from lower to higher. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to select elements to be stored. The number of elements to be stored is equal to the number of active bits in the mask.
14155 The first operand is the input vector, from which elements are collected and written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the element of the input vector operand. The third operand is the mask, a vector of boolean values. The mask and the input vector must have the same number of vector elements.
14161 The '``llvm.masked.compressstore``' intrinsic is designed for compressing data in memory. It allows to collect elements from possibly non-adjacent lanes of a vector and store them contiguously in memory in one IR operation. It is useful for targets that support compressing store operations and allows vectorizing loops with cross-iteration dependences like in the following example:
14165 // In this loop we load elements from A and store them consecutively in B
14166 double *A, B; int *C;
14167 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
14173 .. code-block:: llvm
14175 ; Load elements from A.
14176 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
14177 ; Store all selected elements consecutively in array B
14178 call <void> @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask)
14180 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
14181 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
14182 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
14183 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
14184 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
14187 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
14193 This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
14194 memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
14198 '``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
14199 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14206 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14211 The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
14217 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14218 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14224 This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
14225 of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
14226 to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
14227 that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
14231 '``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
14232 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14239 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14244 The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
14250 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14251 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14257 This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
14258 the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
14259 never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
14260 object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
14262 '``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
14263 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14267 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
14271 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start.p0i8(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14276 The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
14277 a memory object will not change.
14282 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14283 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
14289 This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
14290 the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
14293 '``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
14294 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14298 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
14302 declare void @llvm.invariant.end.p0i8({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
14307 The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
14308 memory object are mutable.
14313 The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
14314 The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
14315 object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
14316 pointer to the object.
14321 This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
14323 '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
14324 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14328 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
14329 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
14334 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
14339 The '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
14340 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new
14341 pointer value that carries fresh invariant group information. It is an
14342 experimental intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the
14349 The ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
14355 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
14356 for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
14357 It does not read any accessible memory and the execution can be speculated.
14359 '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
14360 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14364 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
14365 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
14370 declare i8* @llvm.strip.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
14375 The '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
14376 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
14377 value that does not carry the invariant information. It is an experimental
14378 intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the future.
14384 The ``llvm.strip.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
14390 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which has no associated
14391 ``invariant.group`` metadata.
14392 It does not read any memory and can be speculated.
14398 Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics
14399 -------------------------------------
14401 These intrinsics are used to provide special handling of floating-point
14402 operations when specific rounding mode or floating-point exception behavior is
14403 required. By default, LLVM optimization passes assume that the rounding mode is
14404 round-to-nearest and that floating-point exceptions will not be monitored.
14405 Constrained FP intrinsics are used to support non-default rounding modes and
14406 accurately preserve exception behavior without compromising LLVM's ability to
14407 optimize FP code when the default behavior is used.
14409 Each of these intrinsics corresponds to a normal floating-point operation. The
14410 first two arguments and the return value are the same as the corresponding FP
14413 The third argument is a metadata argument specifying the rounding mode to be
14414 assumed. This argument must be one of the following strings:
14424 If this argument is "round.dynamic" optimization passes must assume that the
14425 rounding mode is unknown and may change at runtime. No transformations that
14426 depend on rounding mode may be performed in this case.
14428 The other possible values for the rounding mode argument correspond to the
14429 similarly named IEEE rounding modes. If the argument is any of these values
14430 optimization passes may perform transformations as long as they are consistent
14431 with the specified rounding mode.
14433 For example, 'x-0'->'x' is not a valid transformation if the rounding mode is
14434 "round.downward" or "round.dynamic" because if the value of 'x' is +0 then
14435 'x-0' should evaluate to '-0' when rounding downward. However, this
14436 transformation is legal for all other rounding modes.
14438 For values other than "round.dynamic" optimization passes may assume that the
14439 actual runtime rounding mode (as defined in a target-specific manner) matches
14440 the specified rounding mode, but this is not guaranteed. Using a specific
14441 non-dynamic rounding mode which does not match the actual rounding mode at
14442 runtime results in undefined behavior.
14444 The fourth argument to the constrained floating-point intrinsics specifies the
14445 required exception behavior. This argument must be one of the following
14454 If this argument is "fpexcept.ignore" optimization passes may assume that the
14455 exception status flags will not be read and that floating-point exceptions will
14456 be masked. This allows transformations to be performed that may change the
14457 exception semantics of the original code. For example, FP operations may be
14458 speculatively executed in this case whereas they must not be for either of the
14459 other possible values of this argument.
14461 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.maytrap" optimization passes
14462 must avoid transformations that may raise exceptions that would not have been
14463 raised by the original code (such as speculatively executing FP operations), but
14464 passes are not required to preserve all exceptions that are implied by the
14465 original code. For example, exceptions may be potentially hidden by constant
14468 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.strict" all transformations must
14469 strictly preserve the floating-point exception semantics of the original code.
14470 Any FP exception that would have been raised by the original code must be raised
14471 by the transformed code, and the transformed code must not raise any FP
14472 exceptions that would not have been raised by the original code. This is the
14473 exception behavior argument that will be used if the code being compiled reads
14474 the FP exception status flags, but this mode can also be used with code that
14475 unmasks FP exceptions.
14477 The number and order of floating-point exceptions is NOT guaranteed. For
14478 example, a series of FP operations that each may raise exceptions may be
14479 vectorized into a single instruction that raises each unique exception a single
14483 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' Intrinsic
14484 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14492 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14493 metadata <rounding mode>,
14494 metadata <exception behavior>)
14499 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' intrinsic returns the sum of its
14506 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``'
14507 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14508 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14510 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14511 behavior as described above.
14516 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two value operands and has
14517 the same type as the operands.
14520 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' Intrinsic
14521 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14529 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14530 metadata <rounding mode>,
14531 metadata <exception behavior>)
14536 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' intrinsic returns the difference
14537 of its two operands.
14543 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``'
14544 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14545 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14547 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14548 behavior as described above.
14553 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two value operands
14554 and has the same type as the operands.
14557 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' Intrinsic
14558 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14566 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14567 metadata <rounding mode>,
14568 metadata <exception behavior>)
14573 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' intrinsic returns the product of
14580 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``'
14581 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14582 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14584 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14585 behavior as described above.
14590 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two value operands and
14591 has the same type as the operands.
14594 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' Intrinsic
14595 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14603 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14604 metadata <rounding mode>,
14605 metadata <exception behavior>)
14610 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' intrinsic returns the quotient of
14617 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``'
14618 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14619 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14621 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14622 behavior as described above.
14627 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two value operands and
14628 has the same type as the operands.
14631 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' Intrinsic
14632 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14640 @llvm.experimental.constrained.frem(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14641 metadata <rounding mode>,
14642 metadata <exception behavior>)
14647 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' intrinsic returns the remainder
14648 from the division of its two operands.
14654 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``'
14655 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
14656 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
14658 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14659 behavior as described above. The rounding mode argument has no effect, since
14660 the result of frem is never rounded, but the argument is included for
14661 consistency with the other constrained floating-point intrinsics.
14666 The value produced is the floating-point remainder from the division of the two
14667 value operands and has the same type as the operands. The remainder has the
14668 same sign as the dividend.
14670 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' Intrinsic
14671 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14679 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fma(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>, <type> <op3>,
14680 metadata <rounding mode>,
14681 metadata <exception behavior>)
14686 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' intrinsic returns the result of a
14687 fused-multiply-add operation on its operands.
14692 The first three arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``'
14693 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
14694 <t_vector>` of floating-point values. All arguments must have identical types.
14696 The fourth and fifth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception behavior
14697 as described above.
14702 The result produced is the product of the first two operands added to the third
14703 operand computed with infinite precision, and then rounded to the target
14706 Constrained libm-equivalent Intrinsics
14707 --------------------------------------
14709 In addition to the basic floating-point operations for which constrained
14710 intrinsics are described above, there are constrained versions of various
14711 operations which provide equivalent behavior to a corresponding libm function.
14712 These intrinsics allow the precise behavior of these operations with respect to
14713 rounding mode and exception behavior to be controlled.
14715 As with the basic constrained floating-point intrinsics, the rounding mode
14716 and exception behavior arguments only control the behavior of the optimizer.
14717 They do not change the runtime floating-point environment.
14720 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' Intrinsic
14721 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14729 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt(<type> <op1>,
14730 metadata <rounding mode>,
14731 metadata <exception behavior>)
14736 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' intrinsic returns the square root
14737 of the specified value, returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``'
14738 functions would, but without setting ``errno``.
14743 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
14746 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14747 behavior as described above.
14752 This function returns the nonnegative square root of the specified value.
14753 If the value is less than negative zero, a floating-point exception occurs
14754 and the return value is architecture specific.
14757 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' Intrinsic
14758 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14766 @llvm.experimental.constrained.pow(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14767 metadata <rounding mode>,
14768 metadata <exception behavior>)
14773 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' intrinsic returns the first operand
14774 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand.
14779 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers of the
14780 same type. The second argument specifies the power to which the first argument
14783 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14784 behavior as described above.
14789 This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
14790 returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
14791 handles error conditions in the same way.
14794 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' Intrinsic
14795 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14803 @llvm.experimental.constrained.powi(<type> <op1>, i32 <op2>,
14804 metadata <rounding mode>,
14805 metadata <exception behavior>)
14810 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' intrinsic returns the first operand
14811 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand. The
14812 order of evaluation of multiplications is not defined. When a vector of
14813 floating-point type is used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
14819 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14820 type. The second argument is a 32-bit signed integer specifying the power to
14821 which the first argument should be raised.
14823 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14824 behavior as described above.
14829 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
14830 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
14833 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' Intrinsic
14834 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14842 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sin(<type> <op1>,
14843 metadata <rounding mode>,
14844 metadata <exception behavior>)
14849 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' intrinsic returns the sine of the
14855 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
14858 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14859 behavior as described above.
14864 This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
14865 same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
14866 conditions in the same way.
14869 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' Intrinsic
14870 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14878 @llvm.experimental.constrained.cos(<type> <op1>,
14879 metadata <rounding mode>,
14880 metadata <exception behavior>)
14885 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' intrinsic returns the cosine of the
14891 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
14894 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14895 behavior as described above.
14900 This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
14901 same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
14902 conditions in the same way.
14905 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' Intrinsic
14906 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14914 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp(<type> <op1>,
14915 metadata <rounding mode>,
14916 metadata <exception behavior>)
14921 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' intrinsic computes the base-e
14922 exponential of the specified value.
14927 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14930 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14931 behavior as described above.
14936 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
14937 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14940 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' Intrinsic
14941 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14949 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2(<type> <op1>,
14950 metadata <rounding mode>,
14951 metadata <exception behavior>)
14956 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
14957 exponential of the specified value.
14963 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14966 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14967 behavior as described above.
14972 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
14973 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14976 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' Intrinsic
14977 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14985 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log(<type> <op1>,
14986 metadata <rounding mode>,
14987 metadata <exception behavior>)
14992 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' intrinsic computes the base-e
14993 logarithm of the specified value.
14998 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15001 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15002 behavior as described above.
15008 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
15009 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15012 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' Intrinsic
15013 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15021 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log10(<type> <op1>,
15022 metadata <rounding mode>,
15023 metadata <exception behavior>)
15028 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' intrinsic computes the base-10
15029 logarithm of the specified value.
15034 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15037 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15038 behavior as described above.
15043 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
15044 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15047 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' Intrinsic
15048 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15056 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log2(<type> <op1>,
15057 metadata <rounding mode>,
15058 metadata <exception behavior>)
15063 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
15064 logarithm of the specified value.
15069 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15072 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15073 behavior as described above.
15078 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
15079 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
15082 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' Intrinsic
15083 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15091 @llvm.experimental.constrained.rint(<type> <op1>,
15092 metadata <rounding mode>,
15093 metadata <exception behavior>)
15098 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' intrinsic returns the first
15099 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point
15100 exception if the operand is not an integer.
15105 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15108 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15109 behavior as described above.
15114 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
15115 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
15116 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15117 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15118 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15121 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' Intrinsic
15122 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15130 @llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint(<type> <op1>,
15131 metadata <rounding mode>,
15132 metadata <exception behavior>)
15137 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' intrinsic returns the first
15138 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It will not raise an inexact
15139 floating-point exception if the operand is not an integer.
15145 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15148 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15149 behavior as described above.
15154 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint`` functions
15155 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
15156 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15157 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15158 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15161 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum``' Intrinsic
15162 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15170 @llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>
15171 metadata <rounding mode>,
15172 metadata <exception behavior>)
15177 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.maxnum``' intrinsic returns the maximum
15178 of the two arguments.
15183 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers
15186 The third and forth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15187 behavior as described above.
15192 This function follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum. The rounding mode is
15193 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15194 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15195 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15198 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum``' Intrinsic
15199 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15207 @llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>
15208 metadata <rounding mode>,
15209 metadata <exception behavior>)
15214 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.minnum``' intrinsic returns the minimum
15215 of the two arguments.
15220 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers
15223 The third and forth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15224 behavior as described above.
15229 This function follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum. The rounding mode is
15230 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
15231 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
15232 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
15235 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil``' Intrinsic
15236 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15244 @llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil(<type> <op1>,
15245 metadata <rounding mode>,
15246 metadata <exception behavior>)
15251 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.ceil``' intrinsic returns the ceiling of the
15257 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15260 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15261 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15267 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
15268 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15271 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.floor``' Intrinsic
15272 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15280 @llvm.experimental.constrained.floor(<type> <op1>,
15281 metadata <rounding mode>,
15282 metadata <exception behavior>)
15287 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.floor``' intrinsic returns the floor of the
15293 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15296 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15297 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15303 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
15304 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15307 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.round``' Intrinsic
15308 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15316 @llvm.experimental.constrained.round(<type> <op1>,
15317 metadata <rounding mode>,
15318 metadata <exception behavior>)
15323 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.round``' intrinsic returns the first
15324 operand rounded to the nearest integer.
15329 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15332 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
15333 behavior as described above. The rounding mode is currently unused for this
15339 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round`` functions
15340 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15343 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc``' Intrinsic
15344 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15352 @llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc(<type> <op1>,
15353 metadata <truncing mode>,
15354 metadata <exception behavior>)
15359 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.trunc``' intrinsic returns the first
15360 operand rounded to the nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the
15366 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
15369 The second and third arguments specify the truncing mode and exception
15370 behavior as described above. The truncing mode is currently unused for this
15376 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
15377 would and handles error conditions in the same way.
15383 This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
15386 '``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
15387 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15394 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15399 The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
15404 The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
15405 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
15406 source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
15411 This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
15412 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
15413 to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
15414 ignored by code generation and optimization.
15416 '``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
15417 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15422 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
15423 pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
15424 the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
15429 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15430 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15431 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15432 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15433 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15438 The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
15443 The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
15444 (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
15445 third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
15446 last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
15451 This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
15452 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
15453 for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
15454 generation and optimization.
15456 '``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
15457 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15462 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
15463 any integer bit width.
15467 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15468 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15469 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15470 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15471 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
15476 The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
15481 The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
15482 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
15483 global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
15484 the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
15489 This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
15490 with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
15491 optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
15492 other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
15494 '``llvm.codeview.annotation``' Intrinsic
15495 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15500 This annotation emits a label at its program point and an associated
15501 ``S_ANNOTATION`` codeview record with some additional string metadata. This is
15502 used to implement MSVC's ``__annotation`` intrinsic. It is marked
15503 ``noduplicate``, so calls to this intrinsic prevent inlining and should be
15504 considered expensive.
15508 declare void @llvm.codeview.annotation(metadata)
15513 The argument should be an MDTuple containing any number of MDStrings.
15515 '``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
15516 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15523 declare void @llvm.trap() cold noreturn nounwind
15528 The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
15538 This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
15539 the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
15540 lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
15542 '``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
15543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15550 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
15555 The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
15565 This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
15566 execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
15569 '``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
15570 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15577 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
15582 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
15583 onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
15584 is placed on the stack before local variables.
15589 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
15590 The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
15591 ``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
15592 enough space to hold the value of the guard.
15597 This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
15598 the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
15599 to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
15600 the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
15601 checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
15602 different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
15603 calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
15605 '``llvm.stackguard``' Intrinsic
15606 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15613 declare i8* @llvm.stackguard()
15618 The ``llvm.stackguard`` intrinsic returns the system stack guard value.
15620 It should not be generated by frontends, since it is only for internal usage.
15621 The reason why we create this intrinsic is that we still support IR form Stack
15622 Protector in FastISel.
15632 On some platforms, the value returned by this intrinsic remains unchanged
15633 between loads in the same thread. On other platforms, it returns the same
15634 global variable value, if any, e.g. ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
15636 Currently some platforms have IR-level customized stack guard loading (e.g.
15637 X86 Linux) that is not handled by ``llvm.stackguard()``, while they should be
15640 '``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
15641 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15648 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>, i1 <dynamic>)
15649 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>, i1 <dynamic>)
15654 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to the
15655 optimizer to determine whether a) an operation (like memcpy) will overflow a
15656 buffer that corresponds to an object, or b) that a runtime check for overflow
15657 isn't necessary. An object in this context means an allocation of a specific
15658 class, structure, array, or other object.
15663 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes four arguments. The first argument is a
15664 pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument determines whether
15665 ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true) or -1 (if false) when the object size is
15666 unknown. The third argument controls how ``llvm.objectsize`` acts when ``null``
15667 in address space 0 is used as its pointer argument. If it's ``false``,
15668 ``llvm.objectsize`` reports 0 bytes available when given ``null``. Otherwise, if
15669 the ``null`` is in a non-zero address space or if ``true`` is given for the
15670 third argument of ``llvm.objectsize``, we assume its size is unknown. The fourth
15671 argument to ``llvm.objectsize`` determines if the value should be evaluated at
15674 The second, third, and fourth arguments only accept constants.
15679 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a value representing the size of
15680 the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined, ``llvm.objectsize``
15681 returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending on the ``min`` argument).
15683 '``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
15684 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15689 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
15694 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
15695 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
15696 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
15701 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
15702 most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
15707 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
15708 a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
15709 constant value, variables are not allowed.
15714 This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
15718 '``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
15719 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15726 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
15731 The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
15732 condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
15738 The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
15743 The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
15744 always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
15745 generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
15746 provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
15747 violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
15749 Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
15750 used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
15751 only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
15752 if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
15753 sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
15754 ``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
15755 that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
15760 '``llvm.ssa_copy``' Intrinsic
15761 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15768 declare type @llvm.ssa_copy(type %operand) returned(1) readnone
15773 The first argument is an operand which is used as the returned value.
15778 The ``llvm.ssa_copy`` intrinsic can be used to attach information to
15779 operations by copying them and giving them new names. For example,
15780 the PredicateInfo utility uses it to build Extended SSA form, and
15781 attach various forms of information to operands that dominate specific
15782 uses. It is not meant for general use, only for building temporary
15783 renaming forms that require value splits at certain points.
15787 '``llvm.type.test``' Intrinsic
15788 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15795 declare i1 @llvm.type.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %type) nounwind readnone
15801 The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
15802 metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier <TypeMetadata>`.
15807 The ``llvm.type.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is associated
15808 with the given type identifier.
15810 '``llvm.type.checked.load``' Intrinsic
15811 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15818 declare {i8*, i1} @llvm.type.checked.load(i8* %ptr, i32 %offset, metadata %type) argmemonly nounwind readonly
15824 The first argument is a pointer from which to load a function pointer. The
15825 second argument is the byte offset from which to load the function pointer. The
15826 third argument is a metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier
15832 The ``llvm.type.checked.load`` intrinsic safely loads a function pointer from a
15833 virtual table pointer using type metadata. This intrinsic is used to implement
15834 control flow integrity in conjunction with virtual call optimization. The
15835 virtual call optimization pass will optimize away ``llvm.type.checked.load``
15836 intrinsics associated with devirtualized calls, thereby removing the type
15837 check in cases where it is not needed to enforce the control flow integrity
15840 If the given pointer is associated with a type metadata identifier, this
15841 function returns true as the second element of its return value. (Note that
15842 the function may also return true if the given pointer is not associated
15843 with a type metadata identifier.) If the function's return value's second
15844 element is true, the following rules apply to the first element:
15846 - If the given pointer is associated with the given type metadata identifier,
15847 it is the function pointer loaded from the given byte offset from the given
15850 - If the given pointer is not associated with the given type metadata
15851 identifier, it is one of the following (the choice of which is unspecified):
15853 1. The function pointer that would have been loaded from an arbitrarily chosen
15854 (through an unspecified mechanism) pointer associated with the type
15857 2. If the function has a non-void return type, a pointer to a function that
15858 returns an unspecified value without causing side effects.
15860 If the function's return value's second element is false, the value of the
15861 first element is undefined.
15864 '``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
15865 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15872 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
15877 The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
15878 three intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint`` and
15879 ``llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint``) that can be called with an invoke
15890 This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
15893 '``llvm.experimental.deoptimize``' Intrinsic
15894 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15901 declare type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
15906 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
15907 <deopt_opbundles>`, allow frontends to express transfer of control and
15908 frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized,
15909 hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence
15912 In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript
15913 this intrinsic can be used to implement "uncommon trap" or "side exit" like
15914 functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be
15915 used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
15921 The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is
15922 decided by the :ref:`lowering strategy<deoptimize_lowering>`.
15927 The ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` intrinsic executes an attached
15928 deoptimization continuation (denoted using a :ref:`deoptimization
15929 operand bundle <deopt_opbundles>`) and returns the value returned by
15930 the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
15931 the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference --
15932 as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
15933 invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
15936 Deoptimization continuations expressed using ``"deopt"`` operand bundles always
15937 continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
15938 calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must be in "tail position":
15940 - ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` cannot be invoked.
15941 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction.
15942 - The ``ret`` instruction must return the value produced by the
15943 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` call if there is one, or void.
15945 Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
15946 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` will match the return type of its immediate
15949 The inliner composes the ``"deopt"`` continuations of the caller into the
15950 ``"deopt"`` continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
15951 intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
15953 All declarations of ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must share the
15954 same calling convention.
15956 .. _deoptimize_lowering:
15961 Calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered to calls to the
15962 symbol ``__llvm_deoptimize`` (it is the frontend's responsibility to
15963 ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
15964 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered as if they were formal
15965 arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
15968 '``llvm.experimental.guard``' Intrinsic
15969 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15976 declare void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1, ...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
15981 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
15982 <deopt_opbundles>`, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
15983 optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
15984 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` is defined in terms of
15985 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` -- its body is defined to be
15988 .. code-block:: text
15990 define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
15991 %realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
15992 br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave [, !make.implicit !{}]
15995 call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
16003 with the optional ``[, !make.implicit !{}]`` present if and only if it
16004 is present on the call site. For more details on ``!make.implicit``,
16005 see :doc:`FaultMaps`.
16007 In words, ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` executes the attached
16008 ``"deopt"`` continuation if (but **not** only if) its first argument
16009 is ``false``. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the ``undef``
16010 with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail "spuriously",
16011 i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the "not only
16012 if"); and this allows for "check widening" type optimizations.
16014 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` cannot be invoked.
16017 '``llvm.experimental.widenable.condition``' Intrinsic
16018 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16025 declare i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16030 This intrinsic represents a "widenable condition" which is
16031 boolean expressions with the following property: whether this
16032 expression is `true` or `false`, the program is correct and
16035 Together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles <deopt_opbundles>`,
16036 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` allows frontends to
16037 express guards or checks on optimistic assumptions made during
16038 compilation and represent them as branch instructions on special
16041 While this may appear similar in semantics to `undef`, it is very
16042 different in that an invocation produces a particular, singular
16043 value. It is also intended to be lowered late, and remain available
16044 for specific optimizations and transforms that can benefit from its
16045 special properties.
16055 The intrinsic ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()``
16056 returns either `true` or `false`. For each evaluation of a call
16057 to this intrinsic, the program must be valid and correct both if
16058 it returns `true` and if it returns `false`. This allows
16059 transformation passes to replace evaluations of this intrinsic
16060 with either value whenever one is beneficial.
16062 When used in a branch condition, it allows us to choose between
16063 two alternative correct solutions for the same problem, like
16066 .. code-block:: text
16068 %cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16069 br i1 %cond, label %solution_1, label %solution_2
16072 ; Apply memory-consuming but fast solution for a task.
16075 ; Cheap in memory but slow solution.
16077 Whether the result of intrinsic's call is `true` or `false`,
16078 it should be correct to pick either solution. We can switch
16079 between them by replacing the result of
16080 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` with different
16083 This is how it can be used to represent guards as widenable branches:
16085 .. code-block:: text
16088 ; Unguarded instructions
16089 call void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %cond, <args...>) ["deopt"(<deopt_args...>)]
16090 ; Guarded instructions
16092 Can be expressed in an alternative equivalent form of explicit branch using
16093 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition``:
16095 .. code-block:: text
16098 ; Unguarded instructions
16099 %widenable_condition = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16100 %guard_condition = and i1 %cond, %widenable_condition
16101 br i1 %guard_condition, label %guarded, label %deopt
16104 ; Guarded instructions
16107 call type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"(<deopt_args...>) ]
16109 So the block `guarded` is only reachable when `%cond` is `true`,
16110 and it should be valid to go to the block `deopt` whenever `%cond`
16111 is `true` or `false`.
16113 ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` will never throw, thus
16114 it cannot be invoked.
16119 When ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()`` is used in
16120 condition of a guard represented as explicit branch, it is
16121 legal to widen the guard's condition with any additional
16124 Guard widening looks like replacement of
16126 .. code-block:: text
16128 %widenable_cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16129 %guard_cond = and i1 %cond, %widenable_cond
16130 br i1 %guard_cond, label %guarded, label %deopt
16134 .. code-block:: text
16136 %widenable_cond = call i1 @llvm.experimental.widenable.condition()
16137 %new_cond = and i1 %any_other_cond, %widenable_cond
16138 %new_guard_cond = and i1 %cond, %new_cond
16139 br i1 %new_guard_cond, label %guarded, label %deopt
16141 for this branch. Here `%any_other_cond` is an arbitrarily chosen
16142 well-defined `i1` value. By making guard widening, we may
16143 impose stricter conditions on `guarded` block and bail to the
16144 deopt when the new condition is not met.
16149 Default lowering strategy is replacing the result of
16150 call of ``@llvm.experimental.widenable.condition`` with
16151 constant `true`. However it is always correct to replace
16152 it with any other `i1` value. Any pass can
16153 freely do it if it can benefit from non-default lowering.
16156 '``llvm.load.relative``' Intrinsic
16157 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16164 declare i8* @llvm.load.relative.iN(i8* %ptr, iN %offset) argmemonly nounwind readonly
16169 This intrinsic loads a 32-bit value from the address ``%ptr + %offset``,
16170 adds ``%ptr`` to that value and returns it. The constant folder specifically
16171 recognizes the form of this intrinsic and the constant initializers it may
16172 load from; if a loaded constant initializer is known to have the form
16173 ``i32 trunc(x - %ptr)``, the intrinsic call is folded to ``x``.
16175 LLVM provides that the calculation of such a constant initializer will
16176 not overflow at link time under the medium code model if ``x`` is an
16177 ``unnamed_addr`` function. However, it does not provide this guarantee for
16178 a constant initializer folded into a function body. This intrinsic can be
16179 used to avoid the possibility of overflows when loading from such a constant.
16181 '``llvm.sideeffect``' Intrinsic
16182 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16189 declare void @llvm.sideeffect() inaccessiblememonly nounwind
16194 The ``llvm.sideeffect`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. Optimizers
16195 treat it as having side effects, so it can be inserted into a loop to
16196 indicate that the loop shouldn't be assumed to terminate (which could
16197 potentially lead to the loop being optimized away entirely), even if it's
16198 an infinite loop with no other side effects.
16208 This intrinsic actually does nothing, but optimizers must assume that it
16209 has externally observable side effects.
16211 '``llvm.is.constant.*``' Intrinsic
16212 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16217 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.is.constant with any argument type.
16221 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.i32(i32 %operand) nounwind readnone
16222 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.f32(float %operand) nounwind readnone
16223 declare i1 @llvm.is.constant.TYPENAME(TYPE %operand) nounwind readnone
16228 The '``llvm.is.constant``' intrinsic will return true if the argument
16229 is known to be a manifest compile-time constant. It is guaranteed to
16230 fold to either true or false before generating machine code.
16235 This intrinsic generates no code. If its argument is known to be a
16236 manifest compile-time constant value, then the intrinsic will be
16237 converted to a constant true value. Otherwise, it will be converted to
16238 a constant false value.
16240 In particular, note that if the argument is a constant expression
16241 which refers to a global (the address of which _is_ a constant, but
16242 not manifest during the compile), then the intrinsic evaluates to
16245 The result also intentionally depends on the result of optimization
16246 passes -- e.g., the result can change depending on whether a
16247 function gets inlined or not. A function's parameters are
16248 obviously not constant. However, a call like
16249 ``llvm.is.constant.i32(i32 %param)`` *can* return true after the
16250 function is inlined, if the value passed to the function parameter was
16253 On the other hand, if constant folding is not run, it will never
16254 evaluate to true, even in simple cases.
16256 Stack Map Intrinsics
16257 --------------------
16259 LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
16260 mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
16261 are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.
16263 Element Wise Atomic Memory Intrinsics
16264 -------------------------------------
16266 These intrinsics are similar to the standard library memory intrinsics except
16267 that they perform memory transfer as a sequence of atomic memory accesses.
16269 .. _int_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic:
16271 '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16272 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16277 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic`` on
16278 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
16279 support all bit widths however.
16283 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16286 i32 <element_size>)
16287 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16290 i32 <element_size>)
16295 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
16296 '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and ``src`` are treated
16297 as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the copy between
16298 buffers uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations
16299 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16304 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`
16305 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
16306 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
16307 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16309 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
16310 target-specific atomic access size limit.
16312 For each of the input pointers ``align`` parameter attribute must be specified. It
16313 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
16314 both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
16319 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes of
16320 memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations are not
16321 allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store operations
16322 where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and
16323 aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16325 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
16326 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
16327 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source and
16328 destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when specified.
16330 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16331 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
16337 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
16338 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
16339 is replaced with an actual element size.
16341 Optimizer is allowed to inline memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
16343 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16344 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16349 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use
16350 ``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic`` on any integer bit width and for
16351 different address spaces. Not all targets support all bit widths however.
16355 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16358 i32 <element_size>)
16359 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16362 i32 <element_size>)
16367 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization
16368 of the '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and
16369 ``src`` are treated as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size``
16370 bytes, and the copy between buffers uses a sequence of
16371 :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations that are a positive
16372 integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16377 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the
16378 :ref:`@llvm.memmove <int_memmove>` intrinsic, with the added constraint that
16379 ``len`` is required to be a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size``.
16380 If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of ``element_size``, then the
16381 behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16383 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no
16384 greater than a target-specific atomic access size limit.
16386 For each of the input pointers the ``align`` parameter attribute must be
16387 specified. It must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller
16388 guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that
16394 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes
16395 of memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations
16396 are allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store
16397 operations where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size``
16398 bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16400 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
16401 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
16402 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source
16403 and destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when
16406 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16407 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
16413 In the most general case call to the
16414 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is lowered to a call to the symbol
16415 ``__llvm_memmove_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*' is replaced with an
16416 actual element size.
16418 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
16420 .. _int_memset_element_unordered_atomic:
16422 '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
16423 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16428 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic`` on
16429 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
16430 support all bit widths however.
16434 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
16437 i32 <element_size>)
16438 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
16441 i32 <element_size>)
16446 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
16447 '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` is treated as an array
16448 with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the assignment to that array
16449 uses uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` store operations
16450 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
16455 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memset <int_memset>`
16456 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
16457 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
16458 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
16460 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
16461 target-specific atomic access size limit.
16463 The ``dest`` input pointer must have the ``align`` parameter attribute specified. It
16464 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
16465 the destination pointer is aligned to that boundary.
16470 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic sets the ``len`` bytes of
16471 memory starting at the destination location to the given ``value``. The memory is
16472 set with a sequence of store operations where each access is guaranteed to be a
16473 multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
16475 The order of the assignment is unspecified. Only one write is issued to the
16476 destination buffer per element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and
16477 writes to the destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic
16480 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
16481 provided by a set of unordered stores to the destination.
16486 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
16487 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memset_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
16488 is replaced with an actual element size.
16490 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory assignment when it's profitable to do so.
16492 Objective-C ARC Runtime Intrinsics
16493 ----------------------------------
16495 LLVM provides intrinsics that lower to Objective-C ARC runtime entry points.
16496 LLVM is aware of the semantics of these functions, and optimizes based on that
16497 knowledge. You can read more about the details of Objective-C ARC `here
16498 <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html>`_.
16500 '``llvm.objc.autorelease``' Intrinsic
16501 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16507 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autorelease(i8*)
16512 Lowers to a call to `objc_autorelease <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-autorelease>`_.
16514 '``llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPop``' Intrinsic
16515 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16521 declare void @llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPop(i8*)
16526 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleasePoolPop <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-autoreleasepoolpop-void-pool>`_.
16528 '``llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPush``' Intrinsic
16529 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16535 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autoreleasePoolPush()
16540 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleasePoolPush <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-autoreleasepoolpush-void>`_.
16542 '``llvm.objc.autoreleaseReturnValue``' Intrinsic
16543 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16549 declare i8* @llvm.objc.autoreleaseReturnValue(i8*)
16554 Lowers to a call to `objc_autoreleaseReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-autoreleasereturnvalue>`_.
16556 '``llvm.objc.copyWeak``' Intrinsic
16557 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16563 declare void @llvm.objc.copyWeak(i8**, i8**)
16568 Lowers to a call to `objc_copyWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-copyweak-id-dest-id-src>`_.
16570 '``llvm.objc.destroyWeak``' Intrinsic
16571 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16577 declare void @llvm.objc.destroyWeak(i8**)
16582 Lowers to a call to `objc_destroyWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-destroyweak-id-object>`_.
16584 '``llvm.objc.initWeak``' Intrinsic
16585 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16591 declare i8* @llvm.objc.initWeak(i8**, i8*)
16596 Lowers to a call to `objc_initWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-initweak>`_.
16598 '``llvm.objc.loadWeak``' Intrinsic
16599 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16605 declare i8* @llvm.objc.loadWeak(i8**)
16610 Lowers to a call to `objc_loadWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-loadweak>`_.
16612 '``llvm.objc.loadWeakRetained``' Intrinsic
16613 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16619 declare i8* @llvm.objc.loadWeakRetained(i8**)
16624 Lowers to a call to `objc_loadWeakRetained <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-loadweakretained>`_.
16626 '``llvm.objc.moveWeak``' Intrinsic
16627 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16633 declare void @llvm.objc.moveWeak(i8**, i8**)
16638 Lowers to a call to `objc_moveWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-moveweak-id-dest-id-src>`_.
16640 '``llvm.objc.release``' Intrinsic
16641 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16647 declare void @llvm.objc.release(i8*)
16652 Lowers to a call to `objc_release <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-release-id-value>`_.
16654 '``llvm.objc.retain``' Intrinsic
16655 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16661 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retain(i8*)
16666 Lowers to a call to `objc_retain <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retain>`_.
16668 '``llvm.objc.retainAutorelease``' Intrinsic
16669 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16675 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutorelease(i8*)
16680 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutorelease <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautorelease>`_.
16682 '``llvm.objc.retainAutoreleaseReturnValue``' Intrinsic
16683 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16689 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutoreleaseReturnValue(i8*)
16694 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautoreleasereturnvalue>`_.
16696 '``llvm.objc.retainAutoreleasedReturnValue``' Intrinsic
16697 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16703 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainAutoreleasedReturnValue(i8*)
16708 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainAutoreleasedReturnValue <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainautoreleasedreturnvalue>`_.
16710 '``llvm.objc.retainBlock``' Intrinsic
16711 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16717 declare i8* @llvm.objc.retainBlock(i8*)
16722 Lowers to a call to `objc_retainBlock <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-retainblock>`_.
16724 '``llvm.objc.storeStrong``' Intrinsic
16725 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16731 declare void @llvm.objc.storeStrong(i8**, i8*)
16736 Lowers to a call to `objc_storeStrong <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#void-objc-storestrong-id-object-id-value>`_.
16738 '``llvm.objc.storeWeak``' Intrinsic
16739 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
16745 declare i8* @llvm.objc.storeWeak(i8**, i8*)
16750 Lowers to a call to `objc_storeWeak <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/AutomaticReferenceCounting.html#arc-runtime-objc-storeweak>`_.